graph: Add "list-backend" and "backend" options.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14
15 @copying
16 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
17 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
18 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
19 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
20 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
21 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
22 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
23 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari@*
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Ricardo Wurmus@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Chris Marusich@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Efraim Flashner@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 ng0@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele
33
34 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
35 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
36 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
37 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
38 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
39 Documentation License''.
40 @end copying
41
42 @dircategory System administration
43 @direntry
44 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
45 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
46 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
47 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
48 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
49 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
50 @end direntry
51
52 @dircategory Software development
53 @direntry
54 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
55 @end direntry
56
57 @dircategory Emacs
58 @direntry
59 * Guix user interface: (guix)Emacs Interface. Package management from the comfort of Emacs.
60 @end direntry
61
62
63 @titlepage
64 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
65 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
66 @author The GNU Guix Developers
67
68 @page
69 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
70 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
71 @value{UPDATED} @*
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end titlepage
75
76 @contents
77
78 @c *********************************************************************
79 @node Top
80 @top GNU Guix
81
82 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
83 package management tool written for the GNU system.
84
85 @menu
86 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
87 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
88 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
89 * Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
90 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
91 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
92 * GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
93 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
94
95 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
96 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
97 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
98 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
99
100 @detailmenu
101 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
102
103 Installation
104
105 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
106 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
107 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
108 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
109 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
110 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
111
112 Setting Up the Daemon
113
114 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
115 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
116
117 Package Management
118
119 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
120 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
121 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
122 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
123 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
124 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
125 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
126
127 Emacs Interface
128
129 * Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
130 * Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
131 * Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
132 * Package Source Locations: Emacs Package Locations. Interface for package location files.
133 * Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
134 * Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
135 * Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
136 * Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
137 * Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
138 * Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
139
140 Programming Interface
141
142 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
143 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
144 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
145 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
146 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
147 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
148
149 Defining Packages
150
151 * package Reference:: The package data type.
152 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
153
154 Utilities
155
156 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
157 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
158 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
159 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
160 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
161 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
162 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
163 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
164 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
165 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
166 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
167 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
168 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
169
170 Invoking @command{guix build}
171
172 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
173 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
174 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
175
176 GNU Distribution
177
178 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
179 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
180 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
181 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
182 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
183 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
184 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
185 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
186
187 System Installation
188
189 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
190 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
191 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
192 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
193 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
194 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
195 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
196
197 System Configuration
198
199 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
200 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
201 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
202 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
203 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
204 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
205 * Services:: Specifying system services.
206 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
207 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
208 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
209 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
210 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
211 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
212 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
213 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
214
215 Services
216
217 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
218 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
219 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
220 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
221 * X Window:: Graphical display.
222 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
223 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
224 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
225 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
226 * Web Services:: Web servers.
227 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
228 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
229
230 Defining Services
231
232 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
233 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
234 * Service Reference:: API reference.
235 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
236
237 Packaging Guidelines
238
239 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
240 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
241 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
242 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
243 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
244 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
245 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
246 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
247
248 Contributing
249
250 * Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
251 * Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
252 * The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
253 * Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
254 * Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
255
256 Coding Style
257
258 * Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
259 * Modules:: Where to store your code?
260 * Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
261 * Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
262
263 @end detailmenu
264 @end menu
265
266 @c *********************************************************************
267 @node Introduction
268 @chapter Introduction
269
270 @cindex purpose
271 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
272 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
273 management tool for the GNU system. Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
274 users to install, upgrade, or remove packages, to roll back to a
275 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
276 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
277
278 @cindex user interfaces
279 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
280 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}), a set of command-line utilities
281 (@pxref{Utilities}), a visual user interface in Emacs (@pxref{Emacs
282 Interface}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
283 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
284 @cindex build daemon
285 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
286 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
287 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
288
289 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
290 @cindex customization, of packages
291 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
292 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
293 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
294 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
295 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
296 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
297 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
298 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
299
300 @cindex Guix System Distribution
301 @cindex GuixSD
302 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system
303 where it complements the available tools without interference
304 (@pxref{Installation}), or you can use it as part of the standalone
305 @dfn{Guix System Distribution} or GuixSD (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
306 With GNU@tie{}GuixSD, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating
307 system configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the
308 configuration in a transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion
309 (@pxref{System Configuration}).
310
311 @cindex functional package management
312 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
313 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
314 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
315 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
316 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
317 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
318 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
319 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
320 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
321 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
322 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
323 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
324 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
325 explicit inputs are visible.
326
327 @cindex store
328 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
329 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
330 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
331 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
332 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
333 input yields a different directory name.
334
335 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
336 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
337 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
338
339
340 @c *********************************************************************
341 @node Installation
342 @chapter Installation
343
344 @cindex installing Guix
345 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
346 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
347 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
348 ready to use it.
349
350 Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
351 manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
352 instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
353 @pxref{System Installation}.
354
355 @cindex foreign distro
356 When installed on a running GNU/Linux system---thereafter called a
357 @dfn{foreign distro}---GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available tools
358 without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
359 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your
360 system, such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
361
362 @menu
363 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
364 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
365 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
366 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
367 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
368 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
369 @end menu
370
371 @node Binary Installation
372 @section Binary Installation
373
374 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
375 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
376 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
377 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
378 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
379 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
380
381 Installing goes along these lines:
382
383 @enumerate
384 @item
385 @cindex downloading Guix binary
386 Download the binary tarball from
387 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
388 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
389 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
390
391 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
392 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
393 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
394
395 @example
396 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
397 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
398 @end example
399
400 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
401 then run this command to import it:
402
403 @example
404 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
405 @end example
406
407 @noindent
408 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
409 @c end authentication part
410
411 @item
412 As @code{root}, run:
413
414 @example
415 # cd /tmp
416 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
417 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
418 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
419 @end example
420
421 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
422 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
423 step.)
424
425 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
426 would overwrite its own essential files.
427
428 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
429 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
430 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
431 versions are fine.)
432 They stem from the fact that all the
433 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
434 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
435 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
436 reproducible.
437
438 @item
439 Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
440
441 @example
442 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
443 ~root/.guix-profile
444 @end example
445
446 @item
447 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
448 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
449
450 @item
451 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
452
453 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
454 with these commands:
455
456 @example
457 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
458 /etc/systemd/system/
459 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
460 @end example
461
462 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
463
464 @example
465 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf /etc/init/
466 # start guix-daemon
467 @end example
468
469 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
470
471 @example
472 # ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
473 @end example
474
475 @item
476 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
477 for instance with:
478
479 @example
480 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
481 # cd /usr/local/bin
482 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
483 @end example
484
485 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
486 there:
487
488 @example
489 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
490 # cd /usr/local/share/info
491 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
492 do ln -s $i ; done
493 @end example
494
495 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
496 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
497 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
498 Info search path.)
499
500 @item
501 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
502 To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or one of its mirrors
503 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
504
505 @example
506 # guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
507 @end example
508 @end enumerate
509
510 This completes root-level install of Guix. Each user will need to
511 perform additional steps to make their Guix environment ready for use,
512 @pxref{Application Setup}.
513
514 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
515 the root profile:
516
517 @example
518 # guix package -i hello
519 @end example
520
521 The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s profile,
522 or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which case you
523 would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the @command{guix}
524 command. In other words, do not remove @code{guix} by running
525 @code{guix package -r guix}.
526
527 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
528 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
529
530 @example
531 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
532 @end example
533
534
535 @node Requirements
536 @section Requirements
537
538 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
539 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
540 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
541 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
542
543 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
544
545 @itemize
546 @item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
547 @item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
548 @item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
549 @end itemize
550
551 The following dependencies are optional:
552
553 @itemize
554 @item
555 Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will allow you to
556 access @code{https} URLs for substitutes, which is highly recommended
557 (@pxref{Substitutes}). It also allows you to access HTTPS URLs with the
558 @command{guix download} command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the
559 @command{guix import pypi} command, and the @command{guix import cpan}
560 command. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings
561 for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
562
563 @item
564 Installing
565 @url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
566 allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
567 guix import}). It is of
568 interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
569
570 @item
571 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
572 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) depends on
573 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
574 version 0.10.2 or later.
575
576 @item
577 When @url{http://zlib.net, zlib} is available, @command{guix publish}
578 can compress build byproducts (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
579 @end itemize
580
581 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
582 following packages are also needed:
583
584 @itemize
585 @item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
586 @item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
587 @item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
588 C++11 standard.
589 @end itemize
590
591 @cindex state directory
592 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
593 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
594 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
595 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
596 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
597 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
598 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
599
600 @cindex Nix, compatibility
601 When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
602 manager} is available, you
603 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
604 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
605
606 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
607 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
608 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
609 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
610 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
611 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
612 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
613 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
614 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
615
616 @node Running the Test Suite
617 @section Running the Test Suite
618
619 @cindex test suite
620 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
621 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
622 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
623 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
624 suite, type:
625
626 @example
627 make check
628 @end example
629
630 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
631 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
632 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
633 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
634 cache.
635
636 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
637 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
638
639 @example
640 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
641 @end example
642
643 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
644 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
645 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
646
647 @example
648 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
649 @end example
650
651 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
652 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
653 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
654 your message.
655
656 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
657 GuixSD operating system instances. It can only run on systems where
658 Guix is already installed, using:
659
660 @example
661 make check-system
662 @end example
663
664 @noindent
665 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
666
667 @example
668 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
669 @end example
670
671 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
672 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
673 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
674 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
675 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
676 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
677
678 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
679 all the details.
680
681 @node Setting Up the Daemon
682 @section Setting Up the Daemon
683
684 @cindex daemon
685 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
686 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
687 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
688 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
689 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
690 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
691 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
692
693 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
694 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
695 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
696
697 @menu
698 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
699 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
700 @end menu
701
702 @node Build Environment Setup
703 @subsection Build Environment Setup
704
705 @cindex build environment
706 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
707 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
708 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
709 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
710 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
711 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
712 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
713
714 @cindex build users
715 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
716 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
717 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
718 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
719 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
720 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
721 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
722 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
723 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
724 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
725
726 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
727 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
728
729 @c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
730 @c for why `-G' is needed.
731 @example
732 # groupadd --system guixbuild
733 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
734 do
735 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
736 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
737 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
738 guixbuilder$i;
739 done
740 @end example
741
742 @noindent
743 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
744 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
745 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
746 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
747 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
748 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
749 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
750
751 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
752 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
753 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
754 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
755 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
756 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
757 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
758 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
759
760 @example
761 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
762 @end example
763
764 @cindex chroot
765 @noindent
766 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
767 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
768 environment contains nothing but:
769
770 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
771 @itemize
772 @item
773 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
774 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
775 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
776 can only be created if the host has them.};
777
778 @item
779 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
780 since a separate PID name space is used;
781
782 @item
783 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
784 user @file{nobody};
785
786 @item
787 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
788
789 @item
790 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
791 @code{127.0.0.1};
792
793 @item
794 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
795 @end itemize
796
797 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
798 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
799 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
800 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
801 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
802 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
803 capture the name of their build tree.
804
805 @vindex http_proxy
806 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
807 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
808 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
809
810 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
811 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
812 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
813 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
814 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
815 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
816 @emph{pure} functions.
817
818
819 @node Daemon Offload Setup
820 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
821
822 @cindex offloading
823 @cindex build hook
824 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
825 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
826 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
827 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
828 present.}. When that
829 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
830 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
831 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
832 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
833 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
834 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
835 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
836 build are copied back to the initial machine.
837
838 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
839
840 @example
841 (list (build-machine
842 (name "eightysix.example.org")
843 (system "x86_64-linux")
844 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
845 (user "bob")
846 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
847
848 (build-machine
849 (name "meeps.example.org")
850 (system "mips64el-linux")
851 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
852 (user "alice")
853 (private-key
854 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
855 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
856 @end example
857
858 @noindent
859 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
860 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
861 architecture.
862
863 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
864 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
865 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
866 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
867 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
868 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
869 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
870 detailed below.
871
872 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
873 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
874 builds. The important fields are:
875
876 @table @code
877
878 @item name
879 The host name of the remote machine.
880
881 @item system
882 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
883
884 @item user
885 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
886 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
887 allow non-interactive logins.
888
889 @item host-key
890 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
891 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
892 long string that looks like this:
893
894 @example
895 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
896 @end example
897
898 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
899 key can be found in a file such as
900 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
901
902 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
903 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
904 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
905 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
906
907 @example
908 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
909 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
910 @end example
911
912 @end table
913
914 A number of optional fields may be specified:
915
916 @table @asis
917
918 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
919 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
920
921 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~/.ssh/id_rsa})
922 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
923 OpenSSH format.
924
925 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
926 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
927 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
928
929 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
930 when transferring files to and from build machines.
931
932 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
933 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
934 to on that machine.
935
936 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
937 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
938
939 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
940 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
941 machines with a higher speed factor.
942
943 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
944 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
945 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
946 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
947 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
948
949 @end table
950 @end deftp
951
952 The @code{guile} command must be in the search path on the build
953 machines. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
954 @code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
955 this is the case by running:
956
957 @example
958 ssh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
959 @end example
960
961 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
962 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
963 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
964 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
965 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
966
967 @example
968 # guix archive --generate-key
969 @end example
970
971 @noindent
972 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
973 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
974
975 @example
976 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
977 @end example
978
979 @noindent
980 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
981
982 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
983 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
984 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
985 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
986 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
987
988 @cindex offload test
989 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
990 master node:
991
992 @example
993 # guix offload test
994 @end example
995
996 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
997 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
998 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
999 from it, and report any error in the process.
1000
1001 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1002 command line:
1003
1004 @example
1005 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1006 @end example
1007
1008 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1009 regular expression like this:
1010
1011 @example
1012 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1013 @end example
1014
1015 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1016 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1017
1018 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1019 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1020 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1021 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1022
1023 @example
1024 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1025 @end example
1026
1027 @noindent
1028 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1029
1030 @cindex chroot
1031 @cindex container, build environment
1032 @cindex build environment
1033 @cindex reproducible builds
1034 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1035 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1036 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1037 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1038 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1039 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1040 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1041 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1042 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1043 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1044 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1045
1046 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1047 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1048 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
1049 the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
1050 directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
1051 with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
1052 sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
1053 it would otherwise not hit.
1054
1055 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1056 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1057 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1058
1059 The following command-line options are supported:
1060
1061 @table @code
1062 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1063 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1064 the Daemon, build users}).
1065
1066 @item --no-substitutes
1067 @cindex substitutes
1068 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1069 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1070 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1071
1072 By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
1073 @command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
1074 @code{--no-substitutes}.
1075
1076 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1077 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1078 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1079
1080 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1081 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1082 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1083 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1084 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org https://hydra.gnu.org} is used
1085 (@code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} is a mirror of @code{hydra.gnu.org}).
1086
1087 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1088 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1089
1090 @cindex build hook
1091 @item --no-build-hook
1092 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1093
1094 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1095 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1096 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1097
1098 @item --cache-failures
1099 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1100
1101 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1102 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1103 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1104 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1105
1106 @item --cores=@var{n}
1107 @itemx -c @var{n}
1108 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1109 as available.
1110
1111 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1112 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1113 guix build}).
1114
1115 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1116 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1117 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1118
1119 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1120 @itemx -M @var{n}
1121 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1122 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1123 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1124 Setup}), or simply fail.
1125
1126 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1127 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1128 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1129 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1130 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1131
1132 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1133 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1134 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1135
1136 @item --debug
1137 Produce debugging output.
1138
1139 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1140 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1141 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1142
1143 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1144 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1145
1146 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1147 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1148 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1149 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1150 needs.
1151
1152 @item --disable-chroot
1153 Disable chroot builds.
1154
1155 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1156 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1157 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1158 account.
1159
1160 @item --disable-log-compression
1161 Disable compression of the build logs.
1162
1163 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1164 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1165 them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
1166
1167 @item --disable-deduplication
1168 @cindex deduplication
1169 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1170
1171 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1172 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1173 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1174 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1175 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1176 this optimization.
1177
1178 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1179 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1180 derivations.
1181
1182 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1183 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1184 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
1185
1186 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1187 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1188 corresponding to live outputs.
1189
1190 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1191 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1192 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1193 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1194
1195 Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
1196 @code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
1197 prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
1198 tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
1199 prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
1200 saves rebuilds or downloads.
1201
1202 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1203 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1204 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1205
1206 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1207 on the kernel version number.
1208
1209 @item --lose-logs
1210 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1211 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1212
1213 @item --system=@var{system}
1214 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1215 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1216 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1217
1218 @item --listen=@var{socket}
1219 Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1220 socket. The default socket is
1221 @file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1222 useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1223 daemons on the same machine.
1224 @end table
1225
1226
1227 @node Application Setup
1228 @section Application Setup
1229
1230 @cindex foreign distro
1231 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1232 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1233 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1234
1235 @subsection Locales
1236
1237 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1238 @cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
1239 @vindex LOCPATH
1240 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1241 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1242 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1243 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1244 variable:
1245
1246 @example
1247 $ guix package -i glibc-locales
1248 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1249 @end example
1250
1251 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1252 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1253 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1254 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1255
1256 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1257 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1258 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1259
1260 @enumerate
1261 @item
1262 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1263 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1264 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1265 incompatible locale data.
1266
1267 @item
1268 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1269 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1270 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1271 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1272 data in the right format.
1273 @end enumerate
1274
1275 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1276 versions may be incompatible.
1277
1278 @subsection Name Service Switch
1279
1280 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1281 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1282 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1283 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1284 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1285 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1286 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1287 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1288 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1289 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1290
1291 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1292 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1293 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1294 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1295 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1296
1297 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1298 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1299 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1300 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1301 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1302 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1303 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1304 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1305 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1306 Reference Manual}).
1307
1308 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1309 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1310 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1311 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1312 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1313 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1314 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1315 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1316 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1317
1318 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1319 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1320 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1321 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1322
1323 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1324 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1325 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1326 themselves.
1327
1328 @subsection X11 Fonts
1329
1330 @cindex fonts
1331 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1332 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1333 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1334 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1335 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1336 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1337 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1338
1339 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1340 graphical applications, consider installing
1341 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1342 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1343 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1344 for Chinese languages:
1345
1346 @example
1347 guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1348 @end example
1349
1350 @cindex @code{xterm}
1351 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1352 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1353 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1354
1355 @example
1356 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1357 @end example
1358
1359 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1360 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1361
1362 @example
1363 xset +fp ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype
1364 @end example
1365
1366 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1367 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1368 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1369
1370 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1371
1372 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1373 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1374 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1375
1376 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1377 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1378 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1379 information.
1380
1381 @subsection Emacs Packages
1382
1383 @cindex @code{emacs}
1384 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1385 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1386 sub-directories of
1387 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1388 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1389 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1390 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1391 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1392 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1393 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1394
1395 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1396 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1397 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1398 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1399 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1400
1401 @c TODO What else?
1402
1403 @c *********************************************************************
1404 @node Package Management
1405 @chapter Package Management
1406
1407 @cindex packages
1408 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
1409 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1410 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1411 features.
1412
1413 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
1414 management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
1415 routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1416 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1417 interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
1418
1419 @menu
1420 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
1421 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
1422 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
1423 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
1424 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
1425 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
1426 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
1427 @end menu
1428
1429 @node Features
1430 @section Features
1431
1432 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1433 own directory---something that resembles
1434 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1435 (note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
1436 names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
1437
1438 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1439 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
1440 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1441 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
1442
1443 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
1444 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
1445 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
1446 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1447 simply continues to point to
1448 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
1449 coexist on the same system without any interference.
1450
1451 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1452 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
1453 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
1454
1455 @cindex transactions
1456 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1457 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
1458 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
1459 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
1460 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1461 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1462
1463 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1464 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1465 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
1466 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1467 system configuration on GuixSD is subject to
1468 transactional upgrades and roll-back
1469 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
1470
1471 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1472 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
1473 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
1474 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
1475 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1476 collected.
1477
1478 @cindex reproducibility
1479 @cindex reproducible builds
1480 Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1481 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
1482 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
1483 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1484 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1485 given package installation matches the current state of their
1486 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1487 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1488 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1489 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
1490
1491 @cindex substitutes
1492 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
1493 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
1494 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
1495 downloads it and unpacks it;
1496 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1497 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
1498 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
1499 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
1500 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
1501
1502 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1503 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1504 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1505 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1506 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1507
1508 @node Invoking guix package
1509 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
1510
1511 @cindex installing packages
1512 @cindex removing packages
1513 @cindex package installation
1514 @cindex package removal
1515 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
1516 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1517 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1518 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1519 is:
1520
1521 @example
1522 guix package @var{options}
1523 @end example
1524 @cindex transactions
1525 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
1526 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
1527 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
1528 want to roll back.
1529
1530 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1531 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1532
1533 @example
1534 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1535 @end example
1536
1537 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1538 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1539 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1540 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1541
1542 @cindex profile
1543 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
1544 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
1545 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1546 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1547 variable, and so on.
1548 @cindex search paths
1549 If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1550 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1551 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1552 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1553
1554 @example
1555 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1556 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1557 @end example
1558
1559 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1560 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1561 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
1562 @code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1563 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
1564 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1565 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1566 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1567 package}.
1568
1569 The @var{options} can be among the following:
1570
1571 @table @code
1572
1573 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1574 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1575 Install the specified @var{package}s.
1576
1577 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
1578 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
1579 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
1580 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1581
1582 If no version number is specified, the
1583 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1584 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
1585 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
1586 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1587 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1588 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
1589
1590 @cindex propagated inputs
1591 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
1592 that automatically get installed along with the required package
1593 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1594 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1595 package definitions).
1596
1597 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
1598 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1599 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1600 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1601 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1602 also been explicitly installed by the user.
1603
1604 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
1605 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
1606 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
1607 environment variable definitions are reported here.
1608
1609 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1610 @itemx -e @var{exp}
1611 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1612
1613 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1614 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1615 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1616 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1617
1618 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1619 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1620 multiple-output package.
1621
1622 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1623 @itemx -f @var{file}
1624 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1625
1626 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1627 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1628
1629 @example
1630 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1631 @end example
1632
1633 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
1634 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
1635 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1636 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1637
1638 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1639 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1640 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
1641
1642 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
1643 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1644 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1645 @code{glibc}.
1646
1647 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1648 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1649 @cindex upgrading packages
1650 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1651 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
1652 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
1653
1654 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1655 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1656 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1657 pull}).
1658
1659 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1660 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1661 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1662 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1663 substring ``emacs'':
1664
1665 @example
1666 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1667 @end example
1668
1669 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1670 @itemx -m @var{file}
1671 @cindex profile declaration
1672 @cindex profile manifest
1673 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1674 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1675
1676 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1677 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1678 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1679 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1680 so on.
1681
1682 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1683 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1684 of packages:
1685
1686 @findex packages->manifest
1687 @example
1688 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
1689
1690 (packages->manifest
1691 (list emacs
1692 guile-2.0
1693 ;; Use a specific package output.
1694 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1695 @end example
1696
1697 @item --roll-back
1698 @cindex rolling back
1699 @cindex undoing transactions
1700 @cindex transactions, undoing
1701 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1702 the last transaction.
1703
1704 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1705 before any other actions.
1706
1707 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
1708 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1709 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
1710
1711 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1712 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1713 generations in a profile is always linear.
1714
1715 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1716 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
1717 @cindex generations
1718 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1719
1720 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1721 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1722 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1723 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1724 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1725
1726 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1727 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1728 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1729 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1730
1731 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
1732 @cindex search paths
1733 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1734 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1735 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1736 of the installed packages.
1737
1738 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1739 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1740 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1741 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1742 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1743 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1744 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1745
1746 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1747 shell:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1751 @end example
1752
1753 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1754 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1755 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1756 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1757
1758 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1759 of several profiles. Consider this example:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
1763 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1764 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1765 @end example
1766
1767 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1768 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1769 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1770
1771
1772 @item --profile=@var{profile}
1773 @itemx -p @var{profile}
1774 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1775
1776 @item --verbose
1777 Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
1778 environment on the standard error port.
1779
1780 @item --bootstrap
1781 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1782 useful to distribution developers.
1783
1784 @end table
1785
1786 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
1787 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1788 availability of packages:
1789
1790 @table @option
1791
1792 @item --search=@var{regexp}
1793 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
1794 @cindex searching for packages
1795 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
1796 @var{regexp}. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
1797 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1798 GNU recutils manual}).
1799
1800 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1801 command, for instance:
1802
1803 @example
1804 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
1805 name: glibc
1806 version: 2.17
1807
1808 name: libgc
1809 version: 7.2alpha6
1810 @end example
1811
1812 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1813 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1814
1815 @example
1816 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1817 name: elfutils
1818
1819 name: gmp
1820 @dots{}
1821 @end example
1822
1823 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1824 flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1825 games:
1826
1827 @example
1828 $ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1829 name: gnubg
1830 @dots{}
1831 @end example
1832
1833 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1834 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1835 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1836 keyboards.
1837
1838 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1839 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1840 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1841
1842 @example
1843 $ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1844 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1845 @end example
1846
1847 @noindent
1848 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1849 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1850
1851 @item --show=@var{package}
1852 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1853 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1854 recutils manual}).
1855
1856 @example
1857 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1858 name: python
1859 version: 2.7.6
1860
1861 name: python
1862 version: 3.3.5
1863 @end example
1864
1865 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1866 specific version of it:
1867 @example
1868 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
1869 name: python
1870 version: 3.4.3
1871 @end example
1872
1873
1874
1875 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1876 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
1877 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1878 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1879 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1880
1881 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1882 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1883 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1884 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1885 the store.
1886
1887 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1888 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
1889 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
1890 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1891 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1892
1893 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
1894 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1895 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
1896
1897 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1898 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1899 @cindex generations
1900 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1901 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
1902 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1903 shown.
1904
1905 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1906 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1907 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1908 location of this package in the store.
1909
1910 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1911 generations. Valid patterns include:
1912
1913 @itemize
1914 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1915 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1916 the first one.
1917
1918 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1919 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1920
1921 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1922 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1923 a range must be smaller than its end.
1924
1925 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1926 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1927 second one.
1928
1929 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1930 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
1931 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1932 that are up to 20 days old.
1933 @end itemize
1934
1935 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1936 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
1937 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1938 one.
1939
1940 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
1941 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1942 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1943 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1944 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1945
1946 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1947 zeroth generation is never deleted.
1948
1949 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
1950 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1951
1952 @end table
1953
1954 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
1955 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
1956 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
1957 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1958 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1959 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
1960 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1961 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1962
1963
1964 @node Substitutes
1965 @section Substitutes
1966
1967 @cindex substitutes
1968 @cindex pre-built binaries
1969 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1970 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1971 server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1972 substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1973 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1974
1975 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1976 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1977 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1978 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1979
1980 The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1981 builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
1982 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1983 Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1984 server). This is the
1985 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1986 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1987 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1988 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1989 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1990 option}).
1991
1992 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS@footnote{For HTTPS access,
1993 the Guile bindings of GnuTLS must be installed. @xref{Requirements}.}
1994 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
1995 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
1996 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
1997 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
1998
1999 @cindex security
2000 @cindex digital signatures
2001 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
2002 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or a
2003 mirror thereof, you
2004 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
2005 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
2006 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
2007 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
2008
2009 This public key is installed along with Guix, in
2010 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
2011 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
2012 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
2013 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
2014 Then, you can run something like this:
2015
2016 @example
2017 # guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
2018 @end example
2019
2020 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
2021 should change from something like:
2022
2023 @example
2024 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2025 The following derivations would be built:
2026 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
2027 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
2028 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
2029 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
2030 @dots{}
2031 @end example
2032
2033 @noindent
2034 to something like:
2035
2036 @example
2037 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2038 The following files would be downloaded:
2039 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
2040 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
2041 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
2042 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
2043 @dots{}
2044 @end example
2045
2046 @noindent
2047 This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
2048 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
2049
2050 Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
2051 one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
2052 when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
2053
2054 @vindex http_proxy
2055 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
2056 The @code{http_proxy} environment
2057 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
2058 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
2059 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
2060 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
2061 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
2062
2063 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
2064 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
2065 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
2066 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
2067 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
2068 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
2069
2070 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
2071 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
2072 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
2073 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
2074 build}, and other command-line tools.
2075
2076
2077 @unnumberedsubsec On Trusting Binaries
2078
2079 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
2080 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
2081 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
2082 weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
2083 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
2084 their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
2085 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
2086 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
2087 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
2088
2089 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
2090 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
2091 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
2092 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
2093 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
2094 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
2095 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
2096 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
2097 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
2098 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
2099 @command{guix build --check}}).
2100
2101 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
2102 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
2103 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
2104
2105
2106 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
2107 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
2108
2109 @cindex multiple-output packages
2110 @cindex package outputs
2111 @cindex outputs
2112
2113 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
2114 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
2115 @command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
2116 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
2117 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
2118 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
2119 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
2120 files.
2121
2122 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
2123 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
2124 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
2125 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
2126 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
2127 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
2128 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
2129
2130 @example
2131 guix package -i glib
2132 @end example
2133
2134 @cindex documentation
2135 The command to install its documentation is:
2136
2137 @example
2138 guix package -i glib:doc
2139 @end example
2140
2141 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
2142 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
2143 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
2144 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
2145 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
2146 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
2147 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
2148 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
2149 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
2150
2151 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
2152 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
2153 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
2154 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
2155 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
2156 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
2157 guix package}).
2158
2159
2160 @node Invoking guix gc
2161 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
2162
2163 @cindex garbage collector
2164 @cindex disk space
2165 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
2166 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
2167 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
2168 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
2169 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
2170
2171 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
2172 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
2173 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
2174 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
2175 profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
2176 example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
2177
2178 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
2179 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
2180 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
2181 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
2182 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2183
2184 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
2185 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
2186 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
2187 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
2188 options are as follows:
2189
2190 @table @code
2191 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
2192 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
2193 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
2194 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
2195 specified.
2196
2197 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
2198 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
2199 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
2200 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
2201
2202 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
2203
2204 @item --free-space=@var{free}
2205 @itemx -F @var{free}
2206 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
2207 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
2208 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
2209
2210 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
2211 nothing and exit immediately.
2212
2213 @item --delete
2214 @itemx -d
2215 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
2216 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
2217 they are still live.
2218
2219 @item --list-failures
2220 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
2221
2222 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
2223 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2224 @option{--cache-failures}}).
2225
2226 @item --clear-failures
2227 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
2228
2229 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
2230 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
2231
2232 @item --list-dead
2233 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
2234 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
2235
2236 @item --list-live
2237 Show the list of live store files and directories.
2238
2239 @end table
2240
2241 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
2242
2243 @table @code
2244
2245 @item --references
2246 @itemx --referrers
2247 @cindex package dependencies
2248 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
2249 as arguments.
2250
2251 @item --requisites
2252 @itemx -R
2253 @cindex closure
2254 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
2255 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
2256 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
2257 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
2258
2259 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
2260 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
2261 the graph of references.
2262
2263 @end table
2264
2265 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
2266 store and to control disk usage.
2267
2268 @table @option
2269
2270 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
2271 @cindex integrity, of the store
2272 @cindex integrity checking
2273 Verify the integrity of the store.
2274
2275 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
2276 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
2277
2278 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
2279 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
2280
2281 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
2282 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
2283 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
2284 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
2285 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
2286
2287 @cindex repairing the store
2288 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
2289 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
2290 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
2291 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
2292 system administrator.
2293
2294 @item --optimize
2295 @cindex deduplication
2296 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
2297 @dfn{deduplication}.
2298
2299 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
2300 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
2301 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
2302 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
2303 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
2304
2305 @end table
2306
2307 @node Invoking guix pull
2308 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
2309
2310 @cindex upgrading Guix
2311 @cindex @command{guix pull}
2312 @cindex pull
2313 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
2314 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
2315 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
2316 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
2317 descriptions, and deploys it.
2318
2319 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
2320 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
2321 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
2322 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
2323 become available.
2324
2325 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
2326 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
2327 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
2328 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
2329 versa@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates the
2330 @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest Guix,
2331 and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
2332
2333 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
2334 but it supports the following options:
2335
2336 @table @code
2337 @item --verbose
2338 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
2339
2340 @item --url=@var{url}
2341 Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
2342
2343 By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
2344 @code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
2345
2346 @item --bootstrap
2347 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
2348 useful to Guix developers.
2349 @end table
2350
2351
2352 @node Invoking guix archive
2353 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2354
2355 @cindex @command{guix archive}
2356 @cindex archive
2357 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2358 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2359 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2360 to the store on another machine.
2361
2362 @cindex exporting store items
2363 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
2364
2365 @example
2366 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2367 @end example
2368
2369 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2370 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2371 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2372 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2373 output of @code{emacs}:
2374
2375 @example
2376 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
2377 @end example
2378
2379 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2380 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2381 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2382
2383 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
2384 one would run:
2385
2386 @example
2387 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
2388 @end example
2389
2390 @noindent
2391 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2392 to another like this:
2393
2394 @example
2395 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2396 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2397 @end example
2398
2399 @noindent
2400 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2401 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2402 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2403 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2404 items are missing from the target store.
2405
2406 Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
2407 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2408 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2409 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2410 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2411 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2412 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2413 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2414 deterministic.
2415
2416 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2417 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2418 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2419 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
2420 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2421
2422 The main options are:
2423
2424 @table @code
2425 @item --export
2426 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2427 resulting archive to the standard output.
2428
2429 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2430 @code{--recursive} is passed.
2431
2432 @item -r
2433 @itemx --recursive
2434 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2435 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2436 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2437 of the exported store items.
2438
2439 @item --import
2440 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2441 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
2442 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2443 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
2444
2445 @item --missing
2446 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2447 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2448 the store.
2449
2450 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
2451 @cindex signing, archives
2452 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
2453 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2454 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2455 generate the key pair.
2456
2457 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2458 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
2459 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2460 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2461 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2462 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
2463 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2464 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2465 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
2466
2467 @item --authorize
2468 @cindex authorizing, archives
2469 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2470 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2471 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2472
2473 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2474 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2475 @url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2476 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2477 @url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2478 (SPKI)}.
2479
2480 @item --extract=@var{directory}
2481 @itemx -x @var{directory}
2482 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2483 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2484 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2485
2486 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2487 served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2488
2489 @example
2490 $ wget -O - \
2491 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2492 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2493 @end example
2494
2495 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2496 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2497 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2498 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2499 unsafe.
2500
2501 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2502 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2503
2504 @end table
2505
2506 @c *********************************************************************
2507 @include emacs.texi
2508
2509 @c *********************************************************************
2510 @node Programming Interface
2511 @chapter Programming Interface
2512
2513 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2514 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2515 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2516 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2517 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2518 turned into concrete build actions.
2519
2520 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
2521 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
2522 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
2523 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2524 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2525
2526 @cindex derivation
2527 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2528 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2529 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2530 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2531 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
2532 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2533 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
2534
2535 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2536 package definitions.
2537
2538 @menu
2539 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
2540 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
2541 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2542 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2543 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
2544 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
2545 @end menu
2546
2547 @node Defining Packages
2548 @section Defining Packages
2549
2550 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2551 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2552 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2553 package looks like this:
2554
2555 @example
2556 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
2557 #:use-module (guix packages)
2558 #:use-module (guix download)
2559 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
2560 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2561 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
2562
2563 (define-public hello
2564 (package
2565 (name "hello")
2566 (version "2.10")
2567 (source (origin
2568 (method url-fetch)
2569 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2570 ".tar.gz"))
2571 (sha256
2572 (base32
2573 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
2574 (build-system gnu-build-system)
2575 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
2576 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
2577 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2578 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
2579 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
2580 (license gpl3+)))
2581 @end example
2582
2583 @noindent
2584 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
2585 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
2586 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2587 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2588 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2589 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2590 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2591
2592 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2593 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2594 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2595
2596 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
2597 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2598 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2599 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2600 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2601
2602 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2603
2604 @itemize
2605 @item
2606 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2607 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
2608 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2609 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2610
2611 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2612 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2613
2614 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2615 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2616 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
2617 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
2618 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2619 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
2620
2621 @cindex patches
2622 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2623 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2624 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2625
2626 @item
2627 @cindex GNU Build System
2628 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2629 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2630 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2631 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2632 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2633
2634 @item
2635 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2636 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2637 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2638 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
2639
2640 @cindex quote
2641 @cindex quoting
2642 @findex '
2643 @findex quote
2644 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
2645 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
2646 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
2647 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
2648 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
2649 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
2650 Manual}).
2651
2652 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
2653 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
2654 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
2655 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
2656 Reference Manual}).
2657
2658 @item
2659 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2660 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2661 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2662 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2663
2664 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
2665 @findex `
2666 @findex quasiquote
2667 @cindex comma (unquote)
2668 @findex ,
2669 @findex unquote
2670 @findex ,@@
2671 @findex unquote-splicing
2672 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
2673 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
2674 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
2675 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
2676 Reference Manual}).
2677
2678 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2679 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
2680 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
2681
2682 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2683 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2684 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2685 @end itemize
2686
2687 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2688
2689 Once a package definition is in place, the
2690 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
2691 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2692 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2693 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2694 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
2695 more information on how to test package definitions, and
2696 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2697 for style conformance.
2698
2699 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2700 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2701 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
2702
2703 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2704 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
2705 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
2706 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
2707 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2708
2709 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
2710 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2711 (@pxref{Derivations}).
2712
2713 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2714 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2715 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2716 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2717 (@pxref{The Store}).
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 @noindent
2721 @cindex cross-compilation
2722 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2723 package for some other system:
2724
2725 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2726 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
2727 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2728 @var{system} to @var{target}.
2729
2730 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2731 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2732 (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2733 Configure and Build System}).
2734 @end deffn
2735
2736 @cindex package transformations
2737 @cindex input rewriting
2738 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
2739 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
2740 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
2741 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
2742
2743 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
2744 [@var{rewrite-name}]
2745 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
2746 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
2747 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
2748 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
2749 is the replacement.
2750
2751 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
2752 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @noindent
2756 Consider this example:
2757
2758 @example
2759 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
2760 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
2761 ;; recursively.
2762 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
2763
2764 (define git-with-libressl
2765 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
2766 @end example
2767
2768 @noindent
2769 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
2770 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
2771 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
2772 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
2773 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
2774
2775 @menu
2776 * package Reference :: The package data type.
2777 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2778 @end menu
2779
2780
2781 @node package Reference
2782 @subsection @code{package} Reference
2783
2784 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2785 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2786
2787 @deftp {Data Type} package
2788 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2789
2790 @table @asis
2791 @item @code{name}
2792 The name of the package, as a string.
2793
2794 @item @code{version}
2795 The version of the package, as a string.
2796
2797 @item @code{source}
2798 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
2799 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
2800 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
2801 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
2802 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
2803 @code{local-file}}).
2804
2805 @item @code{build-system}
2806 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2807 Systems}).
2808
2809 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2810 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2811 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2812
2813 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2814 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2815 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2816 @cindex inputs, of packages
2817 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2818 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2819 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2820 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2821 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2822 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
2823 inputs:
2824
2825 @example
2826 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
2827 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2828 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2829 @end example
2830
2831 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2832 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2833 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2834 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2835 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2836 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2837
2838 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
2839 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2840 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2841 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2842
2843 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2844 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2845 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
2846 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2847 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2848 propagated inputs.)
2849
2850 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2851 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2852 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2853
2854 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
2855 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
2856 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
2857 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2858 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2859 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
2860
2861 @item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2862 This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2863 a native input when cross-compiling.
2864
2865 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2866 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2867 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2868
2869 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2870 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2871 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2872 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2873
2874 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2875 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2876 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2877 for details.
2878
2879 @item @code{synopsis}
2880 A one-line description of the package.
2881
2882 @item @code{description}
2883 A more elaborate description of the package.
2884
2885 @item @code{license}
2886 @cindex license, of packages
2887 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
2888 or a list of such values.
2889
2890 @item @code{home-page}
2891 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2892
2893 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2894 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2895 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2896
2897 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2898 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2899
2900 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2901 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
2902 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2903 automatically corrected.
2904 @end table
2905 @end deftp
2906
2907
2908 @node origin Reference
2909 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
2910
2911 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2912 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2913
2914 @deftp {Data Type} origin
2915 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2916
2917 @table @asis
2918 @item @code{uri}
2919 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2920 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2921 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2922 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2923
2924 @item @code{method}
2925 A procedure that handles the URI.
2926
2927 Examples include:
2928
2929 @table @asis
2930 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2931 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2932 @code{uri} field;
2933
2934 @vindex git-fetch
2935 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2936 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2937 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2938 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
2939
2940 @example
2941 (git-reference
2942 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2943 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2944 @end example
2945 @end table
2946
2947 @item @code{sha256}
2948 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2949 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2950 base-32 string.
2951
2952 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
2953 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
2954 guix hash}).
2955
2956 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2957 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2958 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2959 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2960 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
2961 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2962
2963 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2964 A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2965
2966 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
2967 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
2968 @code{%current-target-system}.
2969
2970 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2971 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
2972 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
2973 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2974
2975 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2976 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2977 command.
2978
2979 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2980 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2981 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2982 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2983
2984 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2985 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2986 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2987
2988 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2989 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2990 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2991 @end table
2992 @end deftp
2993
2994
2995 @node Build Systems
2996 @section Build Systems
2997
2998 @cindex build system
2999 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
3000 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
3001 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
3002 dependencies of that build procedure.
3003
3004 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
3005 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
3006 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
3007
3008 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
3009 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
3010 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
3011 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
3012 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
3013 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
3014 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
3015
3016 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
3017 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
3018 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
3019 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
3020 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
3021 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
3022 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
3023
3024 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
3025 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
3026 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
3027
3028 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
3029 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
3030 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
3031 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
3032
3033 @cindex build phases
3034 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
3035 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
3036 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
3037 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
3038 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
3039 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @item unpack
3043 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
3044 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
3045 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
3046
3047 @item patch-source-shebangs
3048 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
3049 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
3050 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
3051
3052 @item configure
3053 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
3054 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
3055 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
3056
3057 @item build
3058 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
3059 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
3060 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
3061
3062 @item check
3063 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
3064 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
3065 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
3066 check -j}.
3067
3068 @item install
3069 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
3070
3071 @item patch-shebangs
3072 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
3073
3074 @item strip
3075 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
3076 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
3077 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @vindex %standard-phases
3081 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
3082 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
3083 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
3084 procedure implements the actual phase.
3085
3086 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
3087 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
3088
3089 @example
3090 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
3091 @end example
3092
3093 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
3094 @code{configure} phase.
3095
3096 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
3097 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
3098 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
3099 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
3100 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
3101 have to mention them.
3102 @end defvr
3103
3104 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
3105 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
3106 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
3107 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
3108 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
3109
3110 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
3111 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
3112 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
3113 @url{http://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
3114
3115 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
3116 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
3117 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
3118 parameters, respectively.
3119
3120 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
3121 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
3122 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
3123 archive.
3124
3125 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
3126 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
3127 ``jar'' task will be run.
3128
3129 @end defvr
3130
3131 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
3132 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
3133 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
3134
3135 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
3136 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
3137 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
3138 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
3139
3140 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
3141 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
3142 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
3143 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
3144 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
3145 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
3146
3147 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
3148 package itself as well as its run-time dependencies should begin their
3149 name with the lisp implementation, such as @code{sbcl-} for
3150 @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}. Beginning the input name with this
3151 prefix will allow the build system to encode its location into the
3152 resulting library, so that the input can be found at run-time.
3153
3154 If dependencies are used only for tests, it is convenient to use a
3155 different prefix in order to avoid having a run-time dependency on such
3156 systems. For example,
3157
3158 @example
3159 (define-public sbcl-bordeaux-threads
3160 (package
3161 ...
3162 (native-inputs `(("tests:cl-fiveam" ,sbcl-fiveam)))
3163 ...))
3164 @end example
3165
3166 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
3167 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
3168 the @code{cl-} prefix.
3169
3170 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
3171 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
3172 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
3173 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
3174
3175 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
3176 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
3177 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
3178 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
3179 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
3180 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
3181
3182 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
3183 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
3184 which file the system is defined in.
3185
3186 @end defvr
3187
3188 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
3189 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
3190 implements the build procedure for packages using the
3191 @url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
3192
3193 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
3194 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
3195 parameter.
3196
3197 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
3198 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
3199 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
3200 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
3201 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
3202 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
3203 @end defvr
3204
3205 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
3206 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
3207 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
3208
3209 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
3210 @var{gnu-build-system}:
3211
3212 @table @code
3213 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
3214 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
3215 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
3216 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
3217 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
3218 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
3219 environment variables.
3220
3221 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
3222 process by listing their names in the
3223 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
3224 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
3225 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
3226 GLib and GTK+.
3227
3228 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
3229 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3230 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
3231 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3232 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
3233 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
3234 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
3235 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
3236 @end table
3237
3238 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
3239 @end defvr
3240
3241 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
3242 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
3243 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
3244 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
3245 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
3246
3247 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
3248 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
3249 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
3250
3251 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
3252 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
3253 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
3254 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
3255 interpreter version.
3256
3257 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
3258 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
3259 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
3260 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
3261 @end defvr
3262
3263 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
3264 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
3265 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
3266 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
3267 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
3268 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
3269 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
3270 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
3271 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
3272 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
3273 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
3274 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
3275
3276 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
3277 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
3278 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
3279
3280 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
3281 @end defvr
3282
3283 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
3284 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
3285 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
3286 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
3287 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
3288 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
3289 are run after installation using the R function
3290 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
3291 @end defvr
3292
3293 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
3294 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
3295 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
3296 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
3297
3298 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
3299 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
3300 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
3301 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
3302 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
3303 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
3304 a traditional source release tarball.
3305
3306 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
3307 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
3308 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
3309 @end defvr
3310
3311 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
3312 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
3313 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
3314 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
3315 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
3316 script.
3317
3318 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
3319 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
3320 @code{#:python} parameter.
3321 @end defvr
3322
3323 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
3324 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
3325 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
3326 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
3327 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
3328 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
3329 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
3330 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
3331 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
3332 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
3333 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
3334 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
3335 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
3336 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
3337
3338 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
3339 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
3340 @end defvr
3341
3342 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
3343 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
3344 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
3345 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
3346
3347 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
3348 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
3349 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
3350 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
3351 package is installed in its own directory under
3352 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
3353 @end defvr
3354
3355 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
3356 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
3357 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
3358 and does not have a notion of build phases.
3359
3360 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
3361 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
3362
3363 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
3364 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
3365 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
3366 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
3367 @end defvr
3368
3369 @node The Store
3370 @section The Store
3371
3372 @cindex store
3373 @cindex store items
3374 @cindex store paths
3375
3376 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
3377 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
3378 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
3379 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
3380 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
3381 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
3382 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
3383 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
3384 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
3385
3386 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
3387 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
3388 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
3389 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
3390
3391 @quotation Note
3392 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
3393 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
3394 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
3395
3396 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
3397 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
3398 accidental modifications.
3399 @end quotation
3400
3401 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
3402 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
3403
3404 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
3405 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
3406 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
3407 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
3408 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
3409
3410 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
3411 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
3412 @end deffn
3413
3414 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
3415 Close the connection to @var{server}.
3416 @end deffn
3417
3418 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
3419 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
3420 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
3421 @end defvr
3422
3423 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
3424 argument.
3425
3426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
3427 @cindex invalid store items
3428 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
3429 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
3430 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
3431 build.)
3432
3433 A @code{&nix-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
3434 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
3435 @end deffn
3436
3437 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3438 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
3439 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
3440 resulting store path.
3441 @end deffn
3442
3443 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
3444 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
3445 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
3446 Return @code{#t} on success.
3447 @end deffn
3448
3449 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
3450 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
3451 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
3452 Store Monad}).
3453
3454 @c FIXME
3455 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
3456
3457 @node Derivations
3458 @section Derivations
3459
3460 @cindex derivations
3461 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
3462 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
3463 following pieces of information:
3464
3465 @itemize
3466 @item
3467 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
3468 directory in the store, but may produce more.
3469
3470 @item
3471 The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
3472 files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
3473
3474 @item
3475 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
3476
3477 @item
3478 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
3479 to be passed.
3480
3481 @item
3482 A list of environment variables to be defined.
3483
3484 @end itemize
3485
3486 @cindex derivation path
3487 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
3488 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
3489 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
3490 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
3491 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
3492 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
3493 Store}).
3494
3495 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
3496 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
3497 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
3498 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
3499
3500 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
3501 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3502 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
3503 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
3504 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3505 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
3506 [#:substitutable? #t]
3507 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
3508 @code{<derivation>} object.
3509
3510 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
3511 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
3512 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
3513 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
3514 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
3515 containing this output.
3516
3517 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
3518 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
3519 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
3520 a simple text format.
3521
3522 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
3523 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
3524 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
3525 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
3526
3527 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
3528 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
3529 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
3530 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
3531 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
3532 derivations that download files.
3533
3534 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
3535 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
3536 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
3537 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
3538
3539 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
3540 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
3541 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
3542 host CPU instruction set.
3543 @end deffn
3544
3545 @noindent
3546 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
3547 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
3548 to a Bash executable in the store:
3549
3550 @lisp
3551 (use-modules (guix utils)
3552 (guix store)
3553 (guix derivations))
3554
3555 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3556 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3557 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3558 (derivation store "foo"
3559 bash `("-e" ,builder)
3560 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
3561 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
3562 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
3563 @end lisp
3564
3565 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3566 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3567 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3568 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
3569 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
3570
3571 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3572 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3573 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3574 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
3575
3576 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3577 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3578 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3579 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3580 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3581 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3582 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3583 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3584 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3585 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3586 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3587 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3588 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3589 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3590 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3591 gnu-build-system))}.
3592
3593 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3594 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3595 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3596 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3597 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3598 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3599 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3600
3601 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3602 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3603 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
3604
3605 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
3606 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
3607 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
3608 @var{substitutable?}.
3609 @end deffn
3610
3611 @noindent
3612 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3613 containing one file:
3614
3615 @lisp
3616 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
3617 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
3618 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3619 (lambda (p)
3620 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
3621 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
3622
3623 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
3624 @end lisp
3625
3626
3627 @node The Store Monad
3628 @section The Store Monad
3629
3630 @cindex monad
3631
3632 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3633 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3634 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3635 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3636
3637 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3638 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3639 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3640 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3641 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3642
3643 @cindex monadic values
3644 @cindex monadic functions
3645 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3646 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3647 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3648 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3649 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
3650 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
3651 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3652 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3653 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
3654
3655 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3656
3657 @example
3658 (define (sh-symlink store)
3659 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3660 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3661 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3662 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3663 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3664 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
3665 @end example
3666
3667 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3668 as a monadic function:
3669
3670 @example
3671 (define (sh-symlink)
3672 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
3673 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3674 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3675 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3676 #$output))))
3677 @end example
3678
3679 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3680 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3681 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3682 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3683 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3684
3685 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3686 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3687 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3688
3689 @example
3690 (define (sh-symlink)
3691 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3692 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3693 #$output)))
3694 @end example
3695
3696 @c See
3697 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3698 @c for the funny quote.
3699 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3700 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3701 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3702 @code{run-with-store}:
3703
3704 @example
3705 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3706 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
3707 @end example
3708
3709 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
3710 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3711 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
3712 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3713
3714 @example
3715 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3716 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3717 @end example
3718
3719 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3720 automatically run through the store:
3721
3722 @example
3723 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3724 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3725 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3726 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3727 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3728 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3729 scheme@@(guile-user)>
3730 @end example
3731
3732 @noindent
3733 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3734 @code{store-monad} REPL.
3735
3736 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3737 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
3738
3739 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3740 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3741 in @var{monad}.
3742 @end deffn
3743
3744 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3745 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3746 @end deffn
3747
3748 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
3749 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
3750 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3751 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3752 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3753 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3754 in this example:
3755
3756 @example
3757 (run-with-state
3758 (with-monad %state-monad
3759 (>>= (return 1)
3760 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3761 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3762 'some-state)
3763
3764 @result{} 4
3765 @result{} some-state
3766 @end example
3767 @end deffn
3768
3769 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3770 @var{body} ...
3771 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3772 @var{body} ...
3773 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3774 @var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3775 ``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3776
3777 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3778 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3779 @end deffn
3780
3781 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3782 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3783 returning the result of the last expression.
3784
3785 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3786 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3787 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3788 @end deffn
3789
3790 @cindex state monad
3791 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3792 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3793 monadic procedure calls.
3794
3795 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3796 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3797 the state that is threaded.
3798
3799 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3800 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3801 increments the current state value:
3802
3803 @example
3804 (define (square x)
3805 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3806 (mbegin %state-monad
3807 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3808 (return (* x x)))))
3809
3810 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3811 @result{} (0 1 4)
3812 @result{} 3
3813 @end example
3814
3815 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3816 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3817 @end defvr
3818
3819 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3820 Return the current state as a monadic value.
3821 @end deffn
3822
3823 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3824 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3825 monadic value.
3826 @end deffn
3827
3828 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3829 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3830 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3831 @end deffn
3832
3833 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3834 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3835 The state is assumed to be a list.
3836 @end deffn
3837
3838 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3839 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3840 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3841 @end deffn
3842
3843 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3844 store)} module, is as follows.
3845
3846 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
3847 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3848
3849 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3850 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3851 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
3852 @end defvr
3853
3854 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3855 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3856 open store connection.
3857 @end deffn
3858
3859 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3860 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
3861 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3862 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
3863 @end deffn
3864
3865 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3866 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
3867 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3868 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3869 @var{name} is omitted.
3870
3871 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3872 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3873 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3874
3875 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
3876 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
3877 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
3878 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
3879
3880 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3881
3882 @example
3883 (run-with-store (open-connection)
3884 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3885 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3886 (return (list a b))))
3887
3888 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3889 @end example
3890
3891 @end deffn
3892
3893 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3894 monadic procedures:
3895
3896 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
3897 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3898 [#:output "out"]
3899 Return as a monadic
3900 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3901 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
3902 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3903 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
3904 @end deffn
3905
3906 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
3907 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3908 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3909 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3910 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3911 @end deffn
3912
3913
3914 @node G-Expressions
3915 @section G-Expressions
3916
3917 @cindex G-expression
3918 @cindex build code quoting
3919 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3920 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3921 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3922 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3923 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3924
3925 @cindex strata of code
3926 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
3927 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3928 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
3929 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3930 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3931 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3932 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3933 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3934 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3935 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3936 @command{make}, etc.
3937
3938 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3939 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3940 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
3941 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3942 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
3943 expressions.
3944
3945 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3946 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3947 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3948 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3949 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
3950 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
3951 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
3952 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3953
3954 @itemize
3955 @item
3956 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3957 processes.
3958
3959 @item
3960 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3961 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3962 introduced.
3963
3964 @item
3965 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3966 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3967 processes that use them.
3968 @end itemize
3969
3970 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3971 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3972 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
3973 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3974 such that these objects can also be inserted
3975 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
3976 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3977 add files to the store and to refer to them in
3978 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3979 below.)
3980
3981 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3982
3983 @example
3984 (define build-exp
3985 #~(begin
3986 (mkdir #$output)
3987 (chdir #$output)
3988 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3989 "list-files")))
3990 @end example
3991
3992 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3993 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3994 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3995
3996 @example
3997 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3998 @end example
3999
4000 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
4001 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
4002 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
4003 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
4004 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
4005 output of the derivation.
4006
4007 @cindex cross compilation
4008 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
4009 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
4010 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
4011 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
4012 native package build:
4013
4014 @example
4015 (gexp->derivation "vi"
4016 #~(begin
4017 (mkdir #$output)
4018 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
4019 "-s"
4020 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
4021 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
4022 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
4023 @end example
4024
4025 @noindent
4026 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
4027 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
4028 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
4029
4030 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
4031 @findex with-imported-modules
4032 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
4033 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
4034 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
4035 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
4036
4037 @example
4038 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
4039 #~(begin
4040 (use-modules (guix build utils))
4041 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
4042 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
4043 #~(begin
4044 #$build
4045 (display "success!\n")
4046 #t)))
4047 @end example
4048
4049 @noindent
4050 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
4051 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
4052 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
4053
4054 @cindex module closure
4055 @findex source-module-closure
4056 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
4057 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
4058 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
4059 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
4060 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
4061 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
4062
4063 @example
4064 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
4065
4066 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
4067 '((guix build utils)
4068 (gnu build vm)))
4069 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
4070 #~(begin
4071 (use-modules (guix build utils)
4072 (gnu build vm))
4073 @dots{})))
4074 @end example
4075
4076 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
4077
4078 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
4079 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
4080 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
4081 or more of the following forms:
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @item #$@var{obj}
4085 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
4086 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
4087 supported types, for example a package or a
4088 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
4089 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
4090
4091 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
4092 objects are substituted similarly.
4093
4094 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
4095 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
4096
4097 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
4098
4099 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
4100 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
4101 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
4102 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
4103 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4104
4105 @item #+@var{obj}
4106 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
4107 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
4108 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
4109 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
4110 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
4111
4112 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
4113 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
4114 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
4115 output when @var{output} is omitted.
4116
4117 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4118
4119 @item #$@@@var{lst}
4120 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
4121 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
4122 containing list.
4123
4124 @item #+@@@var{lst}
4125 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
4126 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
4127 @var{lst}.
4128
4129 @end table
4130
4131 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
4132 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
4133 @end deffn
4134
4135 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
4136 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
4137 in their execution environment. @var{modules} must be a list of Guile
4138 module names, such as @code{'((guix build utils) (guix build gremlin))}.
4139
4140 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
4141 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
4142 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
4143 @end deffn
4144
4145 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
4146 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
4147 @end deffn
4148
4149 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
4150 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
4151 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
4152 information about monads.)
4153
4154 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
4155 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
4156 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
4157 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4158 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
4159 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4160 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
4161 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
4162 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4163 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
4164 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
4165 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
4166 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
4167 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
4168 to by @var{exp}.
4169
4170 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
4171 Its meaning is to
4172 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
4173 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
4174 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
4175 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
4176 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
4177
4178 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
4179 applicable.
4180
4181 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
4182 following forms:
4183
4184 @example
4185 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
4186 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
4187 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
4188 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
4189 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
4190 @end example
4191
4192 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
4193 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
4194 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
4195 text format.
4196
4197 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
4198 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
4199 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
4200 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
4201 referenced by the outputs.
4202
4203 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
4204 @end deffn
4205
4206 @cindex file-like objects
4207 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
4208 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
4209 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
4210 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
4211
4212 @example
4213 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
4214 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
4215 @end example
4216
4217 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
4218 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
4219 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
4220 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
4221 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
4222 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
4223 content is directly passed as a string.
4224
4225 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
4226 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
4227 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
4228 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
4229 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
4230 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
4231
4232 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
4233 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
4234 permission bits are kept.
4235
4236 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
4237 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
4238 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
4239 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
4240
4241 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
4242 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
4243 @end deffn
4244
4245 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
4246 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
4247 @var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
4248
4249 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
4250 @end deffn
4251
4252 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
4253 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
4254 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
4255 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
4256 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4257
4258 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
4259 @end deffn
4260
4261 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
4262 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
4263 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
4264
4265 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
4266 command:
4267
4268 @example
4269 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
4270
4271 (gexp->script "list-files"
4272 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
4273 "ls"))
4274 @end example
4275
4276 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
4277 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
4278 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
4279
4280 @example
4281 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
4282 !#
4283 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
4284 @end example
4285 @end deffn
4286
4287 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4288 [#:guile #f]
4289 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
4290 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
4291 script.
4292
4293 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4297 [#:set-load-path? #t]
4298 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
4299 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
4300 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
4301 @var{exp}'s imported modules.
4302
4303 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
4304 or a subset thereof.
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
4308 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
4309 @var{exp}.
4310
4311 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
4312 @end deffn
4313
4314 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4315 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
4316 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
4317 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
4318 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
4319 references to all these.
4320
4321 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
4322 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
4323 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
4324 like this:
4325
4326 @example
4327 (define (profile.sh)
4328 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
4329 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
4330 (text-file* "profile.sh"
4331 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
4332 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
4333 @end example
4334
4335 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
4336 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
4337 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4341 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
4342 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
4343 as in:
4344
4345 @example
4346 (mixed-text-file "profile"
4347 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
4348 @end example
4349
4350 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
4351 @end deffn
4352
4353 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
4354 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
4355 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
4356 @var{suffix} is a string.
4357
4358 As an example, consider this gexp:
4359
4360 @example
4361 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4362 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
4363 "/bin/uname")))
4364 @end example
4365
4366 The same effect could be achieved with:
4367
4368 @example
4369 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4370 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
4371 "/bin/uname")))
4372 @end example
4373
4374 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
4375 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
4376 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
4377 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
4378 @end deffn
4379
4380
4381 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
4382 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
4383 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
4384 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
4385
4386 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
4387 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
4388 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
4389 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
4390 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
4391
4392 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
4393 [#:target #f]
4394 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
4395 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
4396 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
4397 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
4398 @end deffn
4399
4400
4401 @c *********************************************************************
4402 @node Utilities
4403 @chapter Utilities
4404
4405 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
4406 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
4407 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
4408 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
4409
4410 @menu
4411 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
4412 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
4413 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
4414 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
4415 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
4416 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
4417 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
4418 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
4419 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
4420 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4421 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
4422 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
4423 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
4424 @end menu
4425
4426 @node Invoking guix build
4427 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
4428
4429 @cindex package building
4430 @cindex @command{guix build}
4431 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
4432 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
4433 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
4434 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
4435 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
4436
4437 The general syntax is:
4438
4439 @example
4440 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
4441 @end example
4442
4443 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
4444 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
4445 resulting directories:
4446
4447 @example
4448 guix build emacs guile
4449 @end example
4450
4451 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
4452
4453 @example
4454 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
4455 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
4456 @end example
4457
4458 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
4459 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
4460 @code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
4461 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
4462 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
4463 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4464
4465 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
4466 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
4467 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
4468 needed.
4469
4470 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
4471 described in the subsections below.
4472
4473 @menu
4474 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
4475 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
4476 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
4477 @end menu
4478
4479 @node Common Build Options
4480 @subsection Common Build Options
4481
4482 A number of options that control the build process are common to
4483 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
4484 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
4485 following:
4486
4487 @table @code
4488
4489 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
4490 @itemx -L @var{directory}
4491 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
4492 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4493
4494 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
4495 the command-line tools.
4496
4497 @item --keep-failed
4498 @itemx -K
4499 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
4500 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
4501 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
4502
4503 @item --keep-going
4504 @itemx -k
4505 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
4506 all the builds have either completed or failed.
4507
4508 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
4509 derivations has failed.
4510
4511 @item --dry-run
4512 @itemx -n
4513 Do not build the derivations.
4514
4515 @item --fallback
4516 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
4517 packages locally.
4518
4519 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4520 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
4521 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
4522 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
4523 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
4524
4525 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
4526 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
4527 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4528
4529 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
4530 disabled.
4531
4532 @item --no-substitutes
4533 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
4534 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
4535 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4536
4537 @item --no-grafts
4538 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4539 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4540 information on grafts.
4541
4542 @item --rounds=@var{n}
4543 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
4544 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
4545
4546 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
4547 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
4548 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
4549 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
4550
4551 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
4552 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
4553 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
4554 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
4555 the two results.
4556
4557 @item --no-build-hook
4558 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
4559 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
4560 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
4561
4562 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
4563 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
4564 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4565
4566 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
4567 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
4568 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4569
4570 By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
4571 @code{--timeout=0}.
4572
4573 @item --verbosity=@var{level}
4574 Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
4575 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
4576 may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
4577
4578 @item --cores=@var{n}
4579 @itemx -c @var{n}
4580 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
4581 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
4582
4583 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
4584 @itemx -M @var{n}
4585 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
4586 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
4587 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
4588
4589 @end table
4590
4591 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
4592 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
4593 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
4594 derivations)} module.
4595
4596 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
4597 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
4598 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
4599
4600 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
4601 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
4602 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
4603 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
4604 below:
4605
4606 @example
4607 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
4608 @end example
4609
4610 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
4611 the parsed command-line options.
4612 @end defvr
4613
4614
4615 @node Package Transformation Options
4616 @subsection Package Transformation Options
4617
4618 @cindex package variants
4619 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
4620 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
4621 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
4622 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
4623 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
4624 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
4625 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4626
4627 @table @code
4628
4629 @item --with-source=@var{source}
4630 Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
4631 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
4632 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
4633
4634 The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be the one specified on the
4635 command line the name of which matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
4636 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
4637 package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
4638 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
4639
4640 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
4641 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
4642 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
4643 the @code{ed} package:
4644
4645 @example
4646 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
4647 @end example
4648
4649 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
4650 candidates:
4651
4652 @example
4653 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
4654 @end example
4655
4656 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
4657
4658 @example
4659 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
4660 $ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
4661 @end example
4662
4663 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4664 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4665 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4666 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4667 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4668
4669 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
4670 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4671 the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4672
4673 @example
4674 guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4675 @end example
4676
4677 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4678 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4679 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4680
4681 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
4682 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
4683
4684 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4685 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
4686 instead of rebuilding all the dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
4687 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
4688 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4689 information on grafts.
4690
4691 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
4692 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
4693 they currently refer to:
4694
4695 @example
4696 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
4697 @end example
4698
4699 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
4700 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
4701 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
4702 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
4703 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
4704 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
4705 care!
4706
4707 @end table
4708
4709 @node Additional Build Options
4710 @subsection Additional Build Options
4711
4712 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4713 build}.
4714
4715 @table @code
4716
4717 @item --quiet
4718 @itemx -q
4719 Build quietly, without displaying the build log. Upon completion, the
4720 build log is kept in @file{/var} (or similar) and can always be
4721 retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
4722
4723 @item --file=@var{file}
4724 @itemx -f @var{file}
4725
4726 Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4727 evaluates to.
4728
4729 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4730 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4731
4732 @example
4733 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4734 @end example
4735
4736 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4737 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4738 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
4739
4740 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
4741 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4742 version 1.8 of Guile.
4743
4744 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4745 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4746 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4747
4748 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
4749 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4750 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4751
4752 @item --source
4753 @itemx -S
4754 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
4755 themselves.
4756
4757 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
4758 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
4759 source tarball.
4760
4761 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4762 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4763 Packages}).
4764
4765 @item --sources
4766 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4767 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4768 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4769 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4770 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4771 optional argument values:
4772
4773 @table @code
4774 @item package
4775 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4776 as the @code{--source} option.
4777
4778 @item all
4779 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
4780 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4781
4782 @example
4783 $ guix build --sources tzdata
4784 The following derivations will be built:
4785 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4786 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4787 @end example
4788
4789 @item transitive
4790 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
4791 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
4792 prefetch package source for later offline building.
4793
4794 @example
4795 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4796 The following derivations will be built:
4797 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4798 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4799 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4800 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4801 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4802 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4803 @dots{}
4804 @end example
4805
4806 @end table
4807
4808 @item --system=@var{system}
4809 @itemx -s @var{system}
4810 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4811 the system type of the build host.
4812
4813 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4814 different personalities. For instance, passing
4815 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4816 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4817
4818 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4819 @cindex cross-compilation
4820 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4821 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4822 configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4823
4824 @anchor{build-check}
4825 @item --check
4826 @cindex determinism, checking
4827 @cindex reproducibility, checking
4828 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4829 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4830 identical.
4831
4832 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
4833 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
4834 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4835 background information and tools.
4836
4837 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
4838 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
4839 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
4840
4841 @item --derivations
4842 @itemx -d
4843 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4844 packages.
4845
4846 @item --root=@var{file}
4847 @itemx -r @var{file}
4848 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4849 collector root.
4850
4851 @item --log-file
4852 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
4853 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
4854 missing.
4855
4856 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4857 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4858
4859 @example
4860 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4861 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4862 guix build --log-file guile
4863 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4864 @end example
4865
4866 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4867 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4868 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
4869
4870 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
4871 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4872
4873 @example
4874 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4875 https://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4876 @end example
4877
4878 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
4879 @end table
4880
4881
4882 @node Invoking guix edit
4883 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4884
4885 @cindex @command{guix edit}
4886 @cindex package definition, editing
4887 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4888 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
4889 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
4890 For instance:
4891
4892 @example
4893 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
4894 @end example
4895
4896 @noindent
4897 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4898 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
4899 and that of Vim.
4900
4901 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
4902 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
4903 (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will be able to edit the package
4904 recipes. Otherwise, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
4905 for packages currently in the store.
4906
4907 If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides the
4908 @kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
4909 info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by the @kbd{M-x
4910 guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
4911
4912
4913 @node Invoking guix download
4914 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
4915
4916 @cindex @command{guix download}
4917 @cindex downloading package sources
4918 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4919 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4920 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4921 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4922 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4923 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4924
4925 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4926 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4927 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4928 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4929 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4930 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4931
4932 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4933 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4934 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4935 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
4936 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4937 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4938 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
4939
4940 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
4941 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
4942 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
4943 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
4944
4945 The following options are available:
4946
4947 @table @code
4948 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4949 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4950 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
4951 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
4952
4953 @item --no-check-certificate
4954 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
4955
4956 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
4957 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
4958 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
4959
4960 @item --output=@var{file}
4961 @itemx -o @var{file}
4962 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
4963 store.
4964 @end table
4965
4966 @node Invoking guix hash
4967 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4968
4969 @cindex @command{guix hash}
4970 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
4971 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4972 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4973 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4974
4975 The general syntax is:
4976
4977 @example
4978 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4979 @end example
4980
4981 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
4982 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
4983 following options:
4984
4985 @table @code
4986
4987 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4988 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4989 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
4990
4991 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4992 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4993
4994 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4995 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4996 in the definitions of packages.
4997
4998 @item --recursive
4999 @itemx -r
5000 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
5001
5002 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
5003 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
5004 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
5005 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
5006 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
5007 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
5008 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
5009 @c it exists.
5010
5011 @item --exclude-vcs
5012 @itemx -x
5013 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
5014 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
5015
5016 @vindex git-fetch
5017 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
5018 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
5019 Reference}):
5020
5021 @example
5022 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
5023 $ cd foo
5024 $ guix hash -rx .
5025 @end example
5026 @end table
5027
5028 @node Invoking guix import
5029 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
5030
5031 @cindex importing packages
5032 @cindex package import
5033 @cindex package conversion
5034 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
5035 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
5036 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
5037 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
5038 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
5039 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
5040 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5041
5042 The general syntax is:
5043
5044 @example
5045 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
5046 @end example
5047
5048 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
5049 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
5050 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
5051 ``importers'' are:
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @item gnu
5055 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
5056 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
5057 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
5058
5059 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
5060 license needs to be figured out manually.
5061
5062 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
5063 GNU@tie{}Hello:
5064
5065 @example
5066 guix import gnu hello
5067 @end example
5068
5069 Specific command-line options are:
5070
5071 @table @code
5072 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5073 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
5074 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
5075 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
5076 @end table
5077
5078 @item pypi
5079 @cindex pypi
5080 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
5081 Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
5082 @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
5083 description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
5084 the relevant information, including package dependencies. For maximum
5085 efficiency, it is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so
5086 that the importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
5087
5088 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
5089 package:
5090
5091 @example
5092 guix import pypi itsdangerous
5093 @end example
5094
5095 @item gem
5096 @cindex gem
5097 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
5098 RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
5099 installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
5100 JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
5101 most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
5102 some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
5103 synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
5104 Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
5105 native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
5106 packager.
5107
5108 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
5109
5110 @example
5111 guix import gem rails
5112 @end example
5113
5114 @item cpan
5115 @cindex CPAN
5116 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}@footnote{This
5117 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
5118 @xref{Requirements}.}.
5119 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
5120 @uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
5121 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
5122 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
5123 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
5124 list of dependencies.
5125
5126 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
5127 Perl module:
5128
5129 @example
5130 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
5131 @end example
5132
5133 @item cran
5134 @cindex CRAN
5135 @cindex Bioconductor
5136 Import metadata from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
5137 central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
5138 statistical and graphical environment}.
5139
5140 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
5141
5142 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
5143 R package:
5144
5145 @example
5146 guix import cran Cairo
5147 @end example
5148
5149 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
5150 @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
5151 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
5152 genomic data in bioinformatics.
5153
5154 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
5155 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
5156
5157 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
5158 R package:
5159
5160 @example
5161 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
5162 @end example
5163
5164 @item nix
5165 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
5166 @uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
5167 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
5168 @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
5169 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
5170 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
5171 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
5172 package definition.
5173
5174 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
5175 by their canonical upstream variant.
5176
5177 Usually, you will first need to do:
5178
5179 @example
5180 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
5181 @end example
5182
5183 @noindent
5184 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
5185
5186 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
5187 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
5188 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
5189
5190 @example
5191 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
5192 @end example
5193
5194 @item hackage
5195 @cindex hackage
5196 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
5197 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
5198 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
5199 dependencies.
5200
5201 Specific command-line options are:
5202
5203 @table @code
5204 @item --stdin
5205 @itemx -s
5206 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
5207 @item --no-test-dependencies
5208 @itemx -t
5209 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
5210 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
5211 @itemx -e @var{alist}
5212 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
5213 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
5214 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
5215 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
5216 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
5217 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
5218 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
5219 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
5220 @end table
5221
5222 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
5223 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
5224 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
5225
5226 @example
5227 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
5228 @end example
5229
5230 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
5231 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
5232
5233 @example
5234 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
5235 @end example
5236
5237 @item elpa
5238 @cindex elpa
5239 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
5240 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5241
5242 Specific command-line options are:
5243
5244 @table @code
5245 @item --archive=@var{repo}
5246 @itemx -a @var{repo}
5247 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
5248 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
5249 are:
5250 @itemize -
5251 @item
5252 @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
5253 identifier. This is the default.
5254
5255 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
5256 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
5257 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
5258 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
5259 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5260
5261 @item
5262 @uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
5263 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
5264
5265 @item
5266 @uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
5267 identifier.
5268 @end itemize
5269 @end table
5270
5271 @item crate
5272 @cindex crate
5273 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
5274 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
5275 @end table
5276
5277 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
5278 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
5279 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
5280
5281 @node Invoking guix refresh
5282 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
5283
5284 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
5285 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
5286 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
5287 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
5288 upstream version, like this:
5289
5290 @example
5291 $ guix refresh
5292 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
5293 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
5294 @end example
5295
5296 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
5297 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
5298
5299 @example
5300 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
5301 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
5302 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
5303 @end example
5304
5305 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
5306 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
5307 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
5308 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
5309 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
5310 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
5311 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
5312
5313 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
5314 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
5315 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
5316 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
5317 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
5318 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
5319 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
5320 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
5321 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
5322 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
5323
5324 The following options are supported:
5325
5326 @table @code
5327
5328 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5329 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5330 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5331
5332 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5333
5334 @example
5335 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
5336 @end example
5337
5338 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
5339 the packages.)
5340
5341 @item --update
5342 @itemx -u
5343 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
5344 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
5345 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
5346
5347 @example
5348 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
5349 @end example
5350
5351 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
5352
5353 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
5354 @itemx -s @var{subset}
5355 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
5356 @code{non-core}.
5357
5358 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
5359 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
5360 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
5361 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
5362 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
5363 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
5364
5365 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
5366 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
5367 inconvenient.
5368
5369 @item --type=@var{updater}
5370 @itemx -t @var{updater}
5371 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
5372 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
5373
5374 @table @code
5375 @item gnu
5376 the updater for GNU packages;
5377 @item gnome
5378 the updater for GNOME packages;
5379 @item kde
5380 the updater for KDE packages;
5381 @item xorg
5382 the updater for X.org packages;
5383 @item kernel.org
5384 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
5385 @item elpa
5386 the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
5387 @item cran
5388 the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
5389 @item bioconductor
5390 the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
5391 @item pypi
5392 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
5393 @item gem
5394 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
5395 @item github
5396 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
5397 @item hackage
5398 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
5399 @item crate
5400 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
5401 @end table
5402
5403 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
5404 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
5405
5406 @example
5407 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
5408 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
5409 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
5410 @end example
5411
5412 @end table
5413
5414 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
5415 names, as in this example:
5416
5417 @example
5418 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
5419 @end example
5420
5421 @noindent
5422 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
5423 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
5424 effect in this case.
5425
5426 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
5427 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
5428 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
5429 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
5430
5431 @table @code
5432
5433 @item --list-updaters
5434 @itemx -L
5435 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
5436
5437 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
5438 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
5439
5440 @item --list-dependent
5441 @itemx -l
5442 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
5443 result of upgrading one or more packages.
5444
5445 @end table
5446
5447 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
5448 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
5449 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
5450
5451 @example
5452 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
5453 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
5454 hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
5455 @end example
5456
5457 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
5458 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
5459
5460 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
5461
5462 @table @code
5463
5464 @item --gpg=@var{command}
5465 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
5466 for in @code{$PATH}.
5467
5468 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5469 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
5470 of:
5471
5472 @table @code
5473 @item always
5474 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
5475 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
5476
5477 @item never
5478 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
5479
5480 @item interactive
5481 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
5482 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
5483 @end table
5484
5485 @item --key-server=@var{host}
5486 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
5487
5488 @end table
5489
5490 The @code{github} updater uses the
5491 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
5492 releases. When used repeatedly e.g. when refreshing all packages,
5493 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
5494 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
5495 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
5496 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
5497 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
5498 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
5499 otherwise.
5500
5501
5502 @node Invoking guix lint
5503 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
5504
5505 @cindex @command{guix lint}
5506 @cindex package, checking for errors
5507 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
5508 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
5509 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
5510 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
5511 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
5512
5513 @table @code
5514 @item synopsis
5515 @itemx description
5516 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
5517 descriptions and synopses.
5518
5519 @item inputs-should-be-native
5520 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
5521
5522 @item source
5523 @itemx home-page
5524 @itemx mirror-url
5525 @itemx source-file-name
5526 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
5527 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. Check that
5528 the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
5529 just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
5530 @code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
5531
5532 @item cve
5533 @cindex security vulnerabilities
5534 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
5535 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
5536 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
5537 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
5538 NIST}.
5539
5540 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
5541
5542 @itemize
5543 @item
5544 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5545 @item
5546 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5547 @end itemize
5548
5549 @noindent
5550 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
5551 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
5552
5553 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
5554 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
5555 name and version of the package when they differ from the name that Guix
5556 uses, as in this example:
5557
5558 @example
5559 (package
5560 (name "grub")
5561 ;; @dots{}
5562 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
5563 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2"))))
5564 @end example
5565
5566 @item formatting
5567 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
5568 use of tabulations, etc.
5569 @end table
5570
5571 The general syntax is:
5572
5573 @example
5574 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5575 @end example
5576
5577 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
5578 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
5579
5580 @table @code
5581 @item --list-checkers
5582 @itemx -l
5583 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
5584 and exit.
5585
5586 @item --checkers
5587 @itemx -c
5588 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
5589 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
5590
5591 @end table
5592
5593 @node Invoking guix size
5594 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
5595
5596 @cindex size
5597 @cindex package size
5598 @cindex closure
5599 @cindex @command{guix size}
5600 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
5601 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
5602 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
5603 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
5604 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
5605 @command{guix size} can highlight.
5606
5607 The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
5608 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
5609 example:
5610
5611 @example
5612 $ guix size coreutils
5613 store item total self
5614 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
5615 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
5616 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
5617 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
5618 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
5619 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
5620 @end example
5621
5622 @cindex closure
5623 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
5624 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
5625 would be returned by:
5626
5627 @example
5628 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
5629 @end example
5630
5631 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
5632 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
5633 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
5634 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
5635 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
5636 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
5637
5638 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
5639 70@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
5640 large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
5641 always available on the system anyway.)
5642
5643 When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
5644 store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
5645 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
5646 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
5647 Coreutils}).
5648
5649 When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
5650 reports information based on the available substitutes
5651 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
5652 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
5653
5654 You can also specify several package names:
5655
5656 @example
5657 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
5658 store item total self
5659 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
5660 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
5661 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
5662 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
5663 @dots{}
5664 total: 102.3 MiB
5665 @end example
5666
5667 @noindent
5668 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
5669 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
5670 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
5671
5672 The available options are:
5673
5674 @table @option
5675
5676 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5677 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
5678 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
5679
5680 @item --map-file=@var{file}
5681 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
5682
5683 For the example above, the map looks like this:
5684
5685 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
5686 produced by @command{guix size}}
5687
5688 This option requires that
5689 @uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
5690 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
5691 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
5692
5693 @item --system=@var{system}
5694 @itemx -s @var{system}
5695 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
5696
5697 @end table
5698
5699 @node Invoking guix graph
5700 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
5701
5702 @cindex DAG
5703 @cindex @command{guix graph}
5704 @cindex package dependencies
5705 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
5706 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
5707 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
5708 provides a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix graph}
5709 emits a DAG representation in the input format of
5710 @uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
5711 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. The general
5712 syntax is:
5713
5714 @example
5715 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5716 @end example
5717
5718 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
5719 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
5720 dependencies:
5721
5722 @example
5723 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5724 @end example
5725
5726 The output looks like this:
5727
5728 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5729
5730 Nice little graph, no?
5731
5732 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
5733 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
5734 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
5735 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
5736 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
5737
5738 @table @code
5739 @item package
5740 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
5741 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
5742 filters out many details.
5743
5744 @item bag-emerged
5745 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
5746
5747 For instance, the following command:
5748
5749 @example
5750 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5751 @end example
5752
5753 ... yields this bigger graph:
5754
5755 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5756
5757 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
5758 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
5759
5760 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
5761 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
5762 here, for conciseness.
5763
5764 @item bag
5765 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
5766 dependencies.
5767
5768 @item bag-with-origins
5769 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
5770
5771 @item derivations
5772 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
5773 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
5774 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
5775 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
5776
5777 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
5778 name instead of a package name, as in:
5779
5780 @example
5781 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
5782 @end example
5783 @end table
5784
5785 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
5786 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
5787
5788 @table @code
5789 @item references
5790 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
5791 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5792
5793 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
5794 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
5795
5796 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
5797 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
5798 (which can be big!):
5799
5800 @example
5801 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
5802 @end example
5803
5804 @item referrers
5805 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
5806 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5807
5808 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
5809 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
5810 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
5811 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
5812 to it.
5813
5814 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
5815 collected.
5816
5817 @end table
5818
5819 The available options are the following:
5820
5821 @table @option
5822 @item --type=@var{type}
5823 @itemx -t @var{type}
5824 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
5825 the values listed above.
5826
5827 @item --list-types
5828 List the supported graph types.
5829
5830 @item --backend=@var{backend}
5831 @itemx -b @var{backend}
5832 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
5833
5834 @item --list-backends
5835 List the supported graph backends.
5836
5837 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5838 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5839 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5840
5841 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5842
5843 @example
5844 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
5845 @end example
5846 @end table
5847
5848
5849 @node Invoking guix environment
5850 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5851
5852 @cindex reproducible build environments
5853 @cindex development environments
5854 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5855 @cindex environment, package build environment
5856 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5857 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5858 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5859 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5860 environment to use them.
5861
5862 The general syntax is:
5863
5864 @example
5865 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5866 @end example
5867
5868 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5869 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5870
5871 @example
5872 guix environment guile
5873 @end example
5874
5875 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5876 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
5877 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
5878 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
5879 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
5880 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
5881 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
5882 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
5883 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
5884 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
5885 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
5886 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
5887 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
5888 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5889 details on Bash start-up files.}.
5890
5891 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5892 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5893 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5894 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5895 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5896 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5897
5898 @example
5899 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5900 then
5901 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5902 fi
5903 @end example
5904
5905 @noindent
5906 ... or to browse the profile:
5907
5908 @example
5909 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5910 @end example
5911
5912 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5913 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5914 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5915 and Emacs are available:
5916
5917 @example
5918 guix environment guile emacs
5919 @end example
5920
5921 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5922 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5923 command from the rest of the arguments:
5924
5925 @example
5926 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5927 @end example
5928
5929 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5930 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5931 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5932 NumPy:
5933
5934 @example
5935 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5936 @end example
5937
5938 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5939 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5940 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5941 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5942 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5943 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5944 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5945 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5946 additionally includes Git and strace:
5947
5948 @example
5949 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5950 @end example
5951
5952 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5953 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5954 using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5955 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5956 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5957 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5958 working directory are mounted:
5959
5960 @example
5961 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5962 @end example
5963
5964 @quotation Note
5965 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5966 @end quotation
5967
5968 The available options are summarized below.
5969
5970 @table @code
5971 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5972 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5973 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5974 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5975
5976 For example, running:
5977
5978 @example
5979 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5980 @end example
5981
5982 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5983 PETSc package.
5984
5985 Running:
5986
5987 @example
5988 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5989 @end example
5990
5991 starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5992
5993 The above commands only the use default output of the given packages.
5994 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5995
5996 @example
5997 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5998 @end example
5999
6000 @item --load=@var{file}
6001 @itemx -l @var{file}
6002 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
6003 within @var{file} evaluates to.
6004
6005 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
6006 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
6007
6008 @example
6009 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
6010 @end example
6011
6012 @item --ad-hoc
6013 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
6014 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
6015 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
6016 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
6017
6018 For instance, the command:
6019
6020 @example
6021 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
6022 @end example
6023
6024 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
6025 available.
6026
6027 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
6028 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
6029 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
6030 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
6031
6032 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
6033 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
6034 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
6035 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
6036 that will be added to the environment directly.
6037
6038 @item --pure
6039 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
6040 This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
6041 only contain package inputs.
6042
6043 @item --search-paths
6044 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
6045 environment.
6046
6047 @item --system=@var{system}
6048 @itemx -s @var{system}
6049 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
6050
6051 @item --container
6052 @itemx -C
6053 @cindex container
6054 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
6055 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
6056 Additionally, a dummy home directory is created that matches the current
6057 user's home directory, and @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
6058 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container, but
6059 has root privileges in the context of the container.
6060
6061 @item --network
6062 @itemx -N
6063 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
6064 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
6065 device.
6066
6067 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
6068 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
6069 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
6070 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
6071 point in the container.
6072
6073 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
6074 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
6075 directory:
6076
6077 @example
6078 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
6079 @end example
6080
6081 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
6082 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
6083 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
6084 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
6085 point in the container.
6086
6087 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
6088 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
6089 @file{/exchange} directory:
6090
6091 @example
6092 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
6093 @end example
6094 @end table
6095
6096 It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
6097 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
6098
6099 @node Invoking guix publish
6100 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
6101
6102 @cindex @command{guix publish}
6103 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
6104 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
6105 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
6106
6107 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
6108 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
6109 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
6110 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
6111 the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
6112
6113 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
6114 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
6115 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
6116 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
6117 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
6118
6119 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
6120 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
6121 guix archive}).
6122
6123 The general syntax is:
6124
6125 @example
6126 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
6127 @end example
6128
6129 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
6130 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
6131
6132 @example
6133 guix publish
6134 @end example
6135
6136 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
6137 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
6138
6139 @example
6140 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
6141 @end example
6142
6143 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
6144 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
6145 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
6146 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
6147 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
6148 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
6149
6150 @example
6151 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
6152 @end example
6153
6154 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
6155 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
6156
6157 The following options are available:
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @item --port=@var{port}
6161 @itemx -p @var{port}
6162 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
6163
6164 @item --listen=@var{host}
6165 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
6166 accept connections from any interface.
6167
6168 @item --user=@var{user}
6169 @itemx -u @var{user}
6170 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
6171 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
6172
6173 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
6174 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
6175 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
6176 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
6177 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
6178 The default is 3.
6179
6180 Compression occurs on the fly and the compressed streams are not
6181 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
6182 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, or to
6183 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy.
6184
6185 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
6186 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
6187 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
6188 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
6189
6190 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
6191 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
6192 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
6193 for as long as @var{ttl}.
6194
6195 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
6196 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
6197 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
6198 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
6199 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
6200 @end table
6201
6202 Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
6203 add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
6204 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
6205 @code{guix-publish-service}}).
6206
6207 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
6208 instructions:”
6209
6210 @itemize
6211 @item
6212 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
6213
6214 @example
6215 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
6216 /etc/systemd/system/
6217 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
6218 @end example
6219
6220 @item
6221 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
6222
6223 @example
6224 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
6225 # start guix-publish
6226 @end example
6227
6228 @item
6229 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
6230 @end itemize
6231
6232 @node Invoking guix challenge
6233 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
6234
6235 @cindex reproducible builds
6236 @cindex verifiable builds
6237 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
6238 @cindex challenge
6239 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
6240 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
6241 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
6242 answer.
6243
6244 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
6245 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
6246 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
6247 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
6248 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
6249 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
6250 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
6251
6252 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
6253 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
6254 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
6255 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
6256 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
6257 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
6258 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
6259 any given store item.
6260
6261 The command output looks like this:
6262
6263 @smallexample
6264 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://hydra.gnu.org https://guix.example.org"
6265 updating list of substitutes from 'https://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
6266 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
6267 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
6268 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
6269 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
6270 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
6271 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
6272 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
6273 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
6274 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
6275 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
6276 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
6277 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
6278 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
6279 @end smallexample
6280
6281 @noindent
6282 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
6283 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
6284 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
6285 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
6286 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
6287
6288 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
6289 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
6290 Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
6291 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
6292 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
6293 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
6294 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
6295 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
6296 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
6297 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
6298 more information.
6299
6300 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
6301 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
6302
6303 @example
6304 $ wget -q -O - https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
6305 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
6306 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
6307 @end example
6308
6309 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
6310 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
6311 @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
6312 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
6313 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
6314 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
6315 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
6316
6317 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
6318 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
6319 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
6320 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
6321 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
6322 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
6323 the problem.
6324
6325 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
6326 whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
6327 same build result as you did with:
6328
6329 @example
6330 $ guix challenge @var{package}
6331 @end example
6332
6333 @noindent
6334 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
6335 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
6336
6337 The general syntax is:
6338
6339 @example
6340 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
6341 @end example
6342
6343 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
6344 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
6345 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
6346 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
6347 errors.)
6348
6349 The one option that matters is:
6350
6351 @table @code
6352
6353 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
6354 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
6355 URLs to compare to.
6356
6357 @end table
6358
6359
6360 @node Invoking guix container
6361 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
6362 @cindex container
6363 @cindex @command{guix container}
6364 @quotation Note
6365 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
6366 is subject to radical change in the future.
6367 @end quotation
6368
6369 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
6370 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
6371 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
6372 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
6373 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
6374
6375 The general syntax is:
6376
6377 @example
6378 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
6379 @end example
6380
6381 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
6382 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
6383
6384 The following actions are available:
6385
6386 @table @code
6387 @item exec
6388 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
6389
6390 The syntax is:
6391
6392 @example
6393 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
6394 @end example
6395
6396 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
6397 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
6398 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
6399 will be passed to @var{program}.
6400
6401 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
6402 GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
6403 process ID is 9001:
6404
6405 @example
6406 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
6407 @end example
6408
6409 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
6410 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
6411
6412 @end table
6413
6414 @c *********************************************************************
6415 @node GNU Distribution
6416 @chapter GNU Distribution
6417
6418 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6419 @cindex GuixSD
6420 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
6421 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
6422 @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
6423 users of that software}.}. The
6424 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
6425 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
6426 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
6427 between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
6428 System Distribution, or GuixSD.
6429
6430 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
6431 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
6432 list of available packages can be browsed
6433 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
6434 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
6435
6436 @example
6437 guix package --list-available
6438 @end example
6439
6440 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
6441 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
6442 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
6443 tools that help users exert that freedom.
6444
6445 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
6446
6447 @table @code
6448
6449 @item x86_64-linux
6450 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
6451
6452 @item i686-linux
6453 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
6454
6455 @item armhf-linux
6456 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
6457 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
6458 and Linux-Libre kernel.
6459
6460 @item mips64el-linux
6461 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
6462 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
6463
6464 @end table
6465
6466 GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
6467
6468 @noindent
6469 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
6470 @pxref{Porting}.
6471
6472 @menu
6473 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
6474 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
6475 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
6476 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
6477 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6478 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
6479 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
6480 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
6481 @end menu
6482
6483 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
6484 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
6485
6486 @node System Installation
6487 @section System Installation
6488
6489 @cindex installing GuixSD
6490 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6491 This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD)
6492 on a machine. The Guix package manager can
6493 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
6494 @pxref{Installation}.
6495
6496 @ifinfo
6497 @quotation Note
6498 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
6499 @c installation image.
6500 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
6501 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6502 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
6503 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
6504
6505 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
6506 available.
6507 @end quotation
6508 @end ifinfo
6509
6510 @menu
6511 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
6512 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
6513 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
6514 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
6515 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
6516 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
6517 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
6518 @end menu
6519
6520 @node Limitations
6521 @subsection Limitations
6522
6523 As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
6524 not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
6525 features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
6526 respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
6527 is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
6528 the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
6529 to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
6530 also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
6531 of it (@pxref{Installation}).
6532
6533 Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
6534 noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
6535
6536 @itemize
6537 @item
6538 The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
6539 requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
6540 get a feel of what that means.)
6541
6542 @item
6543 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
6544
6545 @item
6546 Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
6547 (@pxref{Services}).
6548
6549 @item
6550 More than 4,000 packages are available, but you may
6551 occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
6552
6553 @item
6554 GNOME, Xfce, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
6555 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, some graphical
6556 applications may be missing, as well as KDE.
6557 @end itemize
6558
6559 You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
6560 to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
6561 @xref{Contributing}, for more info.
6562
6563
6564 @node Hardware Considerations
6565 @subsection Hardware Considerations
6566
6567 @cindex hardware support on GuixSD
6568 GNU@tie{}GuixSD focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
6569 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
6570 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
6571 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
6572 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
6573 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
6574 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
6575 hardware is not supported on GuixSD.
6576
6577 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
6578 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
6579 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
6580 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
6581 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
6582 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
6583 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
6584 out-of-the-box on GuixSD, as part of @var{%base-firmware}
6585 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
6586
6587 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
6588 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
6589 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
6590 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
6591 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
6592 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
6593
6594 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
6595 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
6596 about their support in GNU/Linux.
6597
6598
6599 @node USB Stick Installation
6600 @subsection USB Stick Installation
6601
6602 An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
6603 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
6604 where @var{system} is one of:
6605
6606 @table @code
6607 @item x86_64-linux
6608 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
6609
6610 @item i686-linux
6611 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
6612 @end table
6613
6614 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
6615 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
6616 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
6617
6618 @example
6619 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6620 $ gpg --verify guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6621 @end example
6622
6623 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
6624 then run this command to import it:
6625
6626 @example
6627 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
6628 @end example
6629
6630 @noindent
6631 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
6632 @c end duplication
6633
6634 This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
6635 installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
6636 USB stick.
6637
6638 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
6639
6640 @enumerate
6641 @item
6642 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
6643
6644 @example
6645 xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
6646 @end example
6647
6648 @item
6649 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
6650 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
6651 copy the image with:
6652
6653 @example
6654 dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
6655 @end example
6656
6657 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
6658 @end enumerate
6659
6660 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
6661 the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
6662 menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
6663
6664 @xref{Installing GuixSD in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
6665 GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM).
6666
6667 @node Preparing for Installation
6668 @subsection Preparing for Installation
6669
6670 Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
6671 end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
6672 be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
6673 browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
6674 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse
6675 daemon, which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and
6676 to paste it with the middle button.
6677
6678 @quotation Note
6679 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
6680 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
6681 ``Networking'' section below.
6682 @end quotation
6683
6684 The installation system includes many common tools needed for this task.
6685 But it is also a full-blown GuixSD system, which means that you can
6686 install additional packages, should you need it, using @command{guix
6687 package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
6688
6689 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
6690
6691 @cindex keyboard layout
6692 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
6693 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
6694 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
6695
6696 @example
6697 loadkeys dvorak
6698 @end example
6699
6700 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
6701 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
6702 more information.
6703
6704 @subsubsection Networking
6705
6706 Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
6707
6708 @example
6709 ifconfig -a
6710 @end example
6711
6712 @noindent
6713 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
6714
6715 @example
6716 ip a
6717 @end example
6718
6719 @c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
6720 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
6721 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
6722 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
6723 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
6724
6725 @table @asis
6726 @item Wired connection
6727 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
6728 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
6729
6730 @example
6731 ifconfig @var{interface} up
6732 @end example
6733
6734 @item Wireless connection
6735 @cindex wireless
6736 @cindex WiFi
6737 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
6738 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
6739 important) using one of the available text editors such as
6740 @command{zile}:
6741
6742 @example
6743 zile wpa_supplicant.conf
6744 @end example
6745
6746 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
6747 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
6748 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
6749
6750 @example
6751 network=@{
6752 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
6753 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
6754 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
6755 @}
6756 @end example
6757
6758 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
6759 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
6760 network interface you want to use):
6761
6762 @example
6763 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
6764 @end example
6765
6766 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
6767 @end table
6768
6769 @cindex DHCP
6770 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
6771 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
6772
6773 @example
6774 dhclient -v @var{interface}
6775 @end example
6776
6777 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
6778
6779 @example
6780 ping -c 3 gnu.org
6781 @end example
6782
6783 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
6784 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
6785
6786 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
6787
6788 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
6789 then format the target partition(s).
6790
6791 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
6792 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
6793 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
6794 the partition layout you want:
6795
6796 @example
6797 cfdisk
6798 @end example
6799
6800 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
6801 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
6802 GuixSD pretty much assumes an ext4 file system. In particular, code
6803 that reads partition UUIDs and labels only works with ext4. This will
6804 be fixed in the future.}.
6805
6806 Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
6807 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
6808 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
6809 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
6810 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
6811 @code{my-root} can be created with:
6812
6813 @example
6814 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
6815 @end example
6816
6817 @cindex encrypted disk
6818 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
6819 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
6820 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
6821 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
6822 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda1}, the command sequence would
6823 be along these lines:
6824
6825 @example
6826 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda1
6827 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda1 my-partition
6828 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
6829 @end example
6830
6831 Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}
6832 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
6833 root partition):
6834
6835 @example
6836 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
6837 @end example
6838
6839 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
6840 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
6841 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
6842 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, you would run:
6843
6844 @example
6845 mkswap /dev/sda2
6846 @end example
6847
6848 @node Proceeding with the Installation
6849 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
6850
6851 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
6852 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
6853
6854 @example
6855 herd start cow-store /mnt
6856 @end example
6857
6858 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
6859 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
6860 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
6861 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
6862 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
6863
6864 Next, you have to edit a file and
6865 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
6866 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors: GNU nano
6867 (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
6868 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
6869 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
6870 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
6871 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
6872
6873 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
6874 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
6875 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
6876 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
6877 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
6878 something along these lines:
6879
6880 @example
6881 # mkdir /mnt/etc
6882 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
6883 # zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
6884 @end example
6885
6886 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
6887 in particular:
6888
6889 @itemize
6890 @item
6891 Make sure the @code{grub-configuration} form refers to the device you
6892 want to install GRUB on.
6893
6894 @item
6895 Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
6896 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
6897 your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
6898 @code{'label}.
6899
6900 @item
6901 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
6902 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
6903 @end itemize
6904
6905 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
6906 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
6907 under @file{/mnt}):
6908
6909 @example
6910 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
6911 @end example
6912
6913 @noindent
6914 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
6915 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6916 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
6917 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
6918
6919 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
6920 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
6921 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
6922 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
6923 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
6924 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
6925
6926 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
6927 @file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
6928 good.
6929
6930 @node Installing GuixSD in a VM
6931 @subsection Installing GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
6932
6933 @cindex virtual machine, GuixSD installation
6934 If you'd like to install GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) rather than on
6935 your beloved machine, this section is for you.
6936
6937 To boot a @uref{http://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing GuixSD in a
6938 disk image, follow these steps:
6939
6940 @enumerate
6941 @item
6942 First, retrieve the GuixSD installation image as described previously
6943 (@pxref{USB Stick Installation}).
6944
6945 @item
6946 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
6947 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
6948
6949 @example
6950 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 5G
6951 @end example
6952
6953 This will create a 5GB file.
6954
6955 @item
6956 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
6957
6958 @example
6959 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
6960 -net default -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
6961 -drive file=guixsd.img \
6962 -drive file=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}
6963 @end example
6964
6965 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
6966 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
6967 selection.
6968
6969 @item
6970 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
6971 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
6972 @end enumerate
6973
6974 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
6975 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM}, for how to do
6976 that.
6977
6978 @node Building the Installation Image
6979 @subsection Building the Installation Image
6980
6981 @cindex installation image
6982 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
6983 system} command, specifically:
6984
6985 @c FIXME: 1G is too much; see <http://bugs.gnu.org/23077>.
6986 @example
6987 guix system disk-image --image-size=1G gnu/system/install.scm
6988 @end example
6989
6990 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
6991 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
6992 about the installation image.
6993
6994 @node System Configuration
6995 @section System Configuration
6996
6997 @cindex system configuration
6998 The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
6999 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
7000 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
7001 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
7002 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
7003
7004 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
7005 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
7006 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
7007 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
7008 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
7009 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
7010 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
7011 the own tools of the system.
7012 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
7013
7014 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
7015 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
7016 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
7017 instance to support new system services.
7018
7019 @menu
7020 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7021 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
7022 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
7023 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
7024 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
7025 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
7026 * Services:: Specifying system services.
7027 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
7028 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
7029 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
7030 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
7031 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
7032 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
7033 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
7034 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
7035 @end menu
7036
7037 @node Using the Configuration System
7038 @subsection Using the Configuration System
7039
7040 The operating system is configured by providing an
7041 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
7042 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
7043 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
7044 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
7045
7046 @findex operating-system
7047 @lisp
7048 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
7049 @end lisp
7050
7051 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
7052 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
7053 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
7054 which case they get a default value.
7055
7056 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
7057 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
7058 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
7059 @command{guix system}.
7060
7061 @unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
7062
7063 @vindex %base-packages
7064 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
7065 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
7066 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
7067 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
7068 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
7069 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
7070 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
7071 etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
7072 packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7073
7074 @findex specification->package
7075 Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
7076 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
7077 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
7078 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
7079 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
7080 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
7081 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
7082 version:
7083
7084 @lisp
7085 (use-modules (gnu packages))
7086
7087 (operating-system
7088 ;; ...
7089 (packages (append (map specification->package
7090 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
7091 %base-packages)))
7092 @end lisp
7093
7094 @unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
7095
7096 @cindex services
7097 @vindex %base-services
7098 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
7099 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
7100 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
7101 addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
7102 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
7103 @code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
7104 @code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
7105 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
7106 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
7107
7108 @cindex customization, of services
7109 @findex modify-services
7110 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
7111 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
7112 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
7113
7114 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
7115 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
7116 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
7117 following in your operating system declaration:
7118
7119 @lisp
7120 (define %my-services
7121 ;; My very own list of services.
7122 (modify-services %base-services
7123 (guix-service-type config =>
7124 (guix-configuration
7125 (inherit config)
7126 (use-substitutes? #f)
7127 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
7128 (mingetty-service-type config =>
7129 (mingetty-configuration
7130 (inherit config)))))
7131
7132 (operating-system
7133 ;; @dots{}
7134 (services %my-services))
7135 @end lisp
7136
7137 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
7138 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
7139 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
7140 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
7141 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
7142 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
7143 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
7144 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
7145 configuration, but with a few modifications.
7146
7147 @cindex encrypted disk
7148 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
7149 root partition, the X11 display
7150 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
7151 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
7152 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
7153
7154 @lisp
7155 @include os-config-desktop.texi
7156 @end lisp
7157
7158 A graphical environment with a choice of lightweight window managers
7159 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
7160
7161 @lisp
7162 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
7163 @end lisp
7164
7165 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
7166 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
7167 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
7168
7169 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
7170 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
7171 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
7172 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
7173 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
7174 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
7175
7176 @example
7177 (remove (lambda (service)
7178 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
7179 %desktop-services)
7180 @end example
7181
7182 @unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
7183
7184 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
7185 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
7186 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
7187 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
7188 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
7189
7190 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
7191 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
7192 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
7193 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
7194 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
7195 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
7196 system, should you ever need to.
7197
7198 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
7199 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
7200 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
7201 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
7202 an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
7203 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
7204 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
7205 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
7206 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
7207 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
7208
7209 Although the command @command{guix system reconfigure} will not modify
7210 previous generations, must take care when the current generation is not
7211 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
7212 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
7213 system}).
7214
7215 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
7216
7217 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
7218 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
7219 Monad}):
7220
7221 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
7222 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
7223 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
7224
7225 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
7226 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
7227 instantiate @var{os}.
7228 @end deffn
7229
7230 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
7231 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
7232 guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
7233
7234
7235 @node operating-system Reference
7236 @subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
7237
7238 This section summarizes all the options available in
7239 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
7240 System}).
7241
7242 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
7243 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
7244 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
7245 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
7246
7247 @table @asis
7248 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
7249 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7250 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
7251 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
7252
7253 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
7254 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
7255 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
7256
7257 @item @code{bootloader}
7258 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7259
7260 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
7261 @cindex initrd
7262 @cindex initial RAM disk
7263 A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
7264 the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
7265
7266 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
7267 @cindex firmware
7268 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
7269
7270 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
7271 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
7272 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
7273 supported hardware.
7274
7275 @item @code{host-name}
7276 The host name.
7277
7278 @item @code{hosts-file}
7279 @cindex hosts file
7280 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7281 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7282 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7283 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
7284
7285 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
7286 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
7287
7288 @item @code{file-systems}
7289 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
7290
7291 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
7292 @cindex swap devices
7293 A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
7294 (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7295 For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
7296
7297 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7298 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
7299 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
7300
7301 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
7302 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
7303 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
7304 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
7305
7306 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
7307
7308 @example
7309 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
7310 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
7311 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
7312 (activate-readline)")))
7313 @end example
7314
7315 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
7316 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
7317 displayed when users log in on a text console.
7318
7319 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
7320 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
7321 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
7322
7323 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
7324 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
7325 package}).
7326
7327 @item @code{timezone}
7328 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
7329
7330 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
7331 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
7332 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
7333
7334 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
7335 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
7336 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
7337
7338 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
7339 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
7340 run time. @xref{Locales}.
7341
7342 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
7343 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
7344 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
7345 considerations that justify this option.
7346
7347 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
7348 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
7349 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
7350 details.
7351
7352 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
7353 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7354
7355 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
7356 @cindex PAM
7357 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
7358 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
7359 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
7360
7361 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
7362 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
7363 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
7364
7365 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
7366 @cindex sudoers file
7367 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
7368 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7369
7370 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
7371 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
7372 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
7373 @code{sudo}.
7374
7375 @end table
7376 @end deftp
7377
7378 @node File Systems
7379 @subsection File Systems
7380
7381 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
7382 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
7383 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
7384 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
7385
7386 @example
7387 (file-system
7388 (mount-point "/home")
7389 (device "/dev/sda3")
7390 (type "ext4"))
7391 @end example
7392
7393 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
7394 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
7395
7396 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
7397 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
7398 contain the following members:
7399
7400 @table @asis
7401 @item @code{type}
7402 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
7403 @code{"ext4"}.
7404
7405 @item @code{mount-point}
7406 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
7407
7408 @item @code{device}
7409 This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
7410 of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
7411 field described below.
7412
7413 @item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
7414 This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
7415 interpreted.
7416
7417 When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
7418 interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
7419 is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
7420 @code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
7421
7422 UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
7423 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
7424 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
7425 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
7426 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
7427 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
7428 like this:
7429
7430 @example
7431 (file-system
7432 (mount-point "/home")
7433 (type "ext4")
7434 (title 'uuid)
7435 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
7436 @end example
7437
7438 The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
7439 partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
7440 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
7441 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
7442 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
7443 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
7444 mounted.}.
7445
7446 However, when the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
7447 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
7448 device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
7449 @code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
7450 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
7451 corresponding device mapping established.
7452
7453 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
7454 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
7455 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
7456 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
7457 bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
7458
7459 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
7460 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
7461
7462 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
7463 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
7464 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
7465 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
7466 is not automatically mounted.
7467
7468 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
7469 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
7470 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
7471 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
7472 instance, for the root file system.
7473
7474 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
7475 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
7476 errors before being mounted.
7477
7478 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
7479 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
7480
7481 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
7482 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
7483 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
7484 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
7485
7486 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
7487 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
7488 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
7489
7490 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
7491 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
7492 @end table
7493 @end deftp
7494
7495 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
7496 variables.
7497
7498 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
7499 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
7500 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
7501 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
7502 these.
7503 @end defvr
7504
7505 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
7506 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
7507 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
7508 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
7509 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
7510 @command{xterm}.
7511 @end defvr
7512
7513 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
7514 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
7515 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
7516 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7517 @end defvr
7518
7519 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
7520 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
7521 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
7522 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
7523 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
7524
7525 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
7526 read-write in its own ``name space.''
7527 @end defvr
7528
7529 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
7530 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
7531 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
7532 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7533 @end defvr
7534
7535 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
7536 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
7537 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
7538 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7539 @end defvr
7540
7541 @node Mapped Devices
7542 @subsection Mapped Devices
7543
7544 @cindex device mapping
7545 @cindex mapped devices
7546 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
7547 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
7548 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
7549 with additional processing over the data that flows through
7550 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
7551 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
7552 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
7553 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
7554 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
7555 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
7556 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
7557 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
7558 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
7559 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
7560 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
7561 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
7562 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
7563
7564 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
7565 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
7566
7567 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
7568 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
7569 the system boots up.
7570
7571 @table @code
7572 @item source
7573 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
7574 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
7575 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
7576
7577 @item target
7578 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
7579 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
7580 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
7581 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
7582 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
7583 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
7584
7585 @item type
7586 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
7587 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
7588 @end table
7589 @end deftp
7590
7591 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
7592 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
7593 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
7594 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
7595 @end defvr
7596
7597 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
7598 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
7599 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
7600 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
7601 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
7602 @end defvr
7603
7604 @cindex disk encryption
7605 @cindex LUKS
7606 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
7607 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
7608 @url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
7609 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
7610 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
7611 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
7612 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7613
7614 @example
7615 (mapped-device
7616 (source "/dev/sda3")
7617 (target "home")
7618 (type luks-device-mapping))
7619 @end example
7620
7621 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
7622 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
7623 command like:
7624
7625 @example
7626 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
7627 @end example
7628
7629 and use it as follows:
7630
7631 @example
7632 (mapped-device
7633 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
7634 (target "home")
7635 (type luks-device-mapping))
7636 @end example
7637
7638 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
7639 may be declared as follows:
7640
7641 @example
7642 (mapped-device
7643 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
7644 (target "/dev/md0")
7645 (type raid-device-mapping))
7646 @end example
7647
7648 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
7649 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7650 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
7651 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
7652 automatically later.
7653
7654
7655 @node User Accounts
7656 @subsection User Accounts
7657
7658 @cindex users
7659 @cindex accounts
7660 @cindex user accounts
7661 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
7662 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
7663 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
7664
7665 @example
7666 (user-account
7667 (name "alice")
7668 (group "users")
7669 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
7670 "audio" ;sound card
7671 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
7672 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
7673 (comment "Bob's sister")
7674 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
7675 @end example
7676
7677 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
7678 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
7679 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
7680 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
7681 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
7682 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
7683 as declared.
7684
7685 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
7686 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
7687 be specified:
7688
7689 @table @asis
7690 @item @code{name}
7691 The name of the user account.
7692
7693 @item @code{group}
7694 @cindex groups
7695 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
7696 this account belongs to.
7697
7698 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
7699 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
7700 account belongs to.
7701
7702 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
7703 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
7704 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
7705 account is created.
7706
7707 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
7708 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
7709
7710 @item @code{home-directory}
7711 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
7712
7713 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
7714 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
7715 if it does not exist yet.
7716
7717 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
7718 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
7719 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7720
7721 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7722 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
7723 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
7724 graphical login managers do not list them.
7725
7726 @anchor{user-account-password}
7727 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7728 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
7729 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
7730 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
7731 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
7732 reconfiguration.
7733
7734 If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
7735 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
7736 @xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
7737 on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7738 Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
7739
7740 @end table
7741 @end deftp
7742
7743 @cindex groups
7744 User group declarations are even simpler:
7745
7746 @example
7747 (user-group (name "students"))
7748 @end example
7749
7750 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
7751 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
7752
7753 @table @asis
7754 @item @code{name}
7755 The name of the group.
7756
7757 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
7758 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
7759 automatically allocated when the group is created.
7760
7761 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7762 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
7763 System groups have low numerical IDs.
7764
7765 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7766 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
7767 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
7768
7769 @end table
7770 @end deftp
7771
7772 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
7773 expect:
7774
7775 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
7776 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
7777 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
7778 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
7779 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
7780 @end defvr
7781
7782 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
7783 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
7784 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
7785
7786 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
7787 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
7788 @end defvr
7789
7790 @node Locales
7791 @subsection Locales
7792
7793 @cindex locale
7794 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
7795 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7796 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
7797 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
7798 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
7799 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
7800
7801 @cindex locale definition
7802 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
7803 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
7804 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
7805
7806 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
7807 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
7808 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
7809 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
7810 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
7811 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
7812 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
7813 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
7814
7815 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
7816 that field may be:
7817
7818 @example
7819 (cons (locale-definition
7820 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
7821 %default-locale-definitions)
7822 @end example
7823
7824 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
7825 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
7826
7827 @example
7828 (list (locale-definition
7829 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
7830 (charset "EUC-JP")))
7831 @end example
7832
7833 @vindex LOCPATH
7834 The compiled locale definitions are available at
7835 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
7836 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
7837 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
7838 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7839 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7840
7841 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
7842 locale)} module. Details are given below.
7843
7844 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
7845 This is the data type of a locale definition.
7846
7847 @table @asis
7848
7849 @item @code{name}
7850 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7851 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
7852
7853 @item @code{source}
7854 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
7855 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
7856
7857 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
7858 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
7859 @uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
7860 IANA}.
7861
7862 @end table
7863 @end deftp
7864
7865 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
7866 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
7867 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
7868 declarations.
7869
7870 @cindex locale name
7871 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
7872 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
7873 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
7874 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
7875 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
7876 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
7877 @end defvr
7878
7879 @subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
7880
7881 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
7882 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
7883 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
7884 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
7885 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
7886 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
7887 another.
7888
7889 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
7890 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
7891 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
7892 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
7893 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
7894 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
7895 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
7896 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
7897 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
7898 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
7899 programs will not abort.
7900
7901 The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
7902 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
7903 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
7904 used to build the system-wide locale data.
7905
7906 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
7907 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7908 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7909
7910 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
7911 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
7912 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
7913 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
7914 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
7915 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
7916
7917 @example
7918 (use-package-modules base)
7919
7920 (operating-system
7921 ;; @dots{}
7922 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
7923 @end example
7924
7925 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
7926 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
7927 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
7928
7929
7930 @node Services
7931 @subsection Services
7932
7933 @cindex system services
7934 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
7935 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
7936 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
7937 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
7938 configuring network access.
7939
7940 GuixSD has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
7941 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
7942 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
7943 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
7944 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
7945 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
7946
7947 @example
7948 # herd status
7949 @end example
7950
7951 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
7952 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
7953 service:
7954
7955 @example
7956 # herd doc nscd
7957 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
7958 @end example
7959
7960 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
7961 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
7962 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
7963
7964 @example
7965 # herd stop nscd
7966 Service nscd has been stopped.
7967 # herd restart xorg-server
7968 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
7969 Service xorg-server has been started.
7970 @end example
7971
7972 The following sections document the available services, starting with
7973 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
7974 declaration.
7975
7976 @menu
7977 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
7978 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
7979 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
7980 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
7981 * X Window:: Graphical display.
7982 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
7983 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
7984 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
7985 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
7986 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
7987 * Web Services:: Web servers.
7988 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
7989 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
7990 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
7991 @end menu
7992
7993 @node Base Services
7994 @subsubsection Base Services
7995
7996 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
7997 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
7998 this module are listed below.
7999
8000 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
8001 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
8002 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
8003 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
8004 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
8005 more.
8006
8007 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
8008 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
8009 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
8010 this:
8011
8012 @example
8013 (cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
8014 @end example
8015 @end defvr
8016
8017 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
8018 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
8019 @end deffn
8020
8021 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
8022 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
8023 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
8024 among other things.
8025 @end deffn
8026
8027 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
8028 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
8029
8030 @table @asis
8031
8032 @item @code{motd}
8033 @cindex message of the day
8034 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
8035
8036 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
8037 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
8038 the 'root' account has just been created.
8039
8040 @end table
8041 @end deftp
8042
8043 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
8044 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
8045 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
8046 other things.
8047 @end deffn
8048
8049 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
8050 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
8051 implements console log-in.
8052
8053 @table @asis
8054
8055 @item @code{tty}
8056 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
8057
8058 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
8059 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
8060 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
8061 user name and password must be entered to log in.
8062
8063 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
8064 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
8065 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
8066 the name of the log-in program.
8067
8068 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
8069 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
8070 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
8071
8072 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
8073 The Mingetty package to use.
8074
8075 @end table
8076 @end deftp
8077
8078 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
8079 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
8080 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
8081 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
8082 @end deffn
8083
8084 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
8085 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
8086 implements console log-in.
8087
8088 @table @asis
8089
8090 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
8091 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
8092
8093 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
8094 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
8095 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
8096
8097 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
8098 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
8099
8100 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
8101 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
8102
8103 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
8104 The Kmscon package to use.
8105
8106 @end table
8107 @end deftp
8108
8109 @cindex name service cache daemon
8110 @cindex nscd
8111 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
8112 [#:name-services '()]
8113 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
8114 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
8115 Service Switch}, for an example.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
8119 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
8120 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
8121 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
8122 @end defvr
8123
8124 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
8125 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
8126 configuration.
8127
8128 @table @asis
8129
8130 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
8131 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
8132 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
8133
8134 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
8135 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
8136 command.
8137
8138 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
8139 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
8140 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
8141
8142 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
8143 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
8144 debugging output is logged.
8145
8146 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
8147 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
8148 below.
8149
8150 @end table
8151 @end deftp
8152
8153 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
8154 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
8155
8156 @table @asis
8157
8158 @item @code{database}
8159 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
8160 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
8161 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
8162 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8163
8164 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
8165 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
8166 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
8167 negative lookup result remains in cache.
8168
8169 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
8170 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
8171 @var{database}.
8172
8173 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
8174 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
8175 them into account.
8176
8177 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
8178 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
8179
8180 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
8181 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
8182
8183 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
8184 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
8185
8186 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
8187 @c settings, so leave them out.
8188
8189 @end table
8190 @end deftp
8191
8192 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
8193 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
8194 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
8195
8196 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
8197 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
8198 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
8199 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
8200 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
8201 @end defvr
8202
8203 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
8204 @cindex syslog
8205 @cindex logging
8206 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
8207 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
8208
8209 @table @asis
8210 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
8211 The syslog daemon to use.
8212
8213 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
8214 The syslog configuration file to use.
8215
8216 @end table
8217 @end deftp
8218
8219 @anchor{syslog-service}
8220 @cindex syslog
8221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
8222 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
8223
8224 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
8225 information on the configuration file syntax.
8226 @end deffn
8227
8228 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
8229 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
8230 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
8231 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
8232
8233 @table @asis
8234 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
8235 The Guix package to use.
8236
8237 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
8238 Name of the group for build user accounts.
8239
8240 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
8241 Number of build user accounts to create.
8242
8243 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
8244 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
8245 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
8246 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{hydra.gnu.org}
8247 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8248
8249 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
8250 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
8251 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
8252 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
8253 contains that of @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8254
8255 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
8256 Whether to use substitutes.
8257
8258 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
8259 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
8260
8261 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
8262 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
8263
8264 @item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
8265 @itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
8266 The lsof and lsh packages to use.
8267
8268 @end table
8269 @end deftp
8270
8271 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
8272 Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
8273 @var{config}.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
8277 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
8278 @end deffn
8279
8280 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} urandom-seed-service @var{#f}
8281 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
8282 when rebooting.
8283 @end deffn
8284
8285 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
8286 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
8287 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
8288 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
8289 @end defvr
8290
8291 @cindex keymap
8292 @cindex keyboard
8293 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{files} ...
8294 @cindex keyboard layout
8295 Return a service to load console keymaps from @var{files} using
8296 @command{loadkeys} command. Most likely, you want to load some default
8297 keymap, which can be done like this:
8298
8299 @example
8300 (console-keymap-service "dvorak")
8301 @end example
8302
8303 Or, for example, for a Swedish keyboard, you may need to combine
8304 the following keymaps:
8305 @example
8306 (console-keymap-service "se-lat6" "se-fi-lat6")
8307 @end example
8308
8309 Also you can specify a full file name (or file names) of your keymap(s).
8310 See @code{man loadkeys} for details.
8311
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @cindex mouse
8315 @cindex gpm
8316 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
8317 [#:options]
8318 Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
8319 command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
8320 notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
8321 uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
8322
8323 This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @anchor{guix-publish-service}
8327 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
8328 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
8329 Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
8330 and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
8331
8332 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
8333 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
8334 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @anchor{rngd-service}
8338 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
8339 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
8340 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
8341 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
8342 @var{device} does not exist.
8343 @end deffn
8344
8345 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
8346 @cindex session limits
8347 @cindex ulimit
8348 @cindex priority
8349 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @var{limits}]
8350
8351 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
8352 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
8353 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
8354 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
8355 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
8356
8357 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
8358 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
8359
8360 @example
8361 (pam-limits-service
8362 (list
8363 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
8364 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
8365 @end example
8366
8367 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
8368 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
8369 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
8370 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
8371 @end deffn
8372
8373 @node Scheduled Job Execution
8374 @subsubsection Scheduled Job Execution
8375
8376 @cindex cron
8377 @cindex mcron
8378 @cindex scheduling jobs
8379 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
8380 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
8381 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
8382 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
8383 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
8384 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
8385
8386 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
8387 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
8388 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
8389 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
8390 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
8391 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
8392 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8393
8394 @lisp
8395 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
8396 (use-package-modules base idutils)
8397
8398 (define updatedb-job
8399 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
8400 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
8401 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
8402 (lambda ()
8403 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
8404 "updatedb"
8405 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
8406
8407 (define garbage-collector-job
8408 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
8409 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
8410 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
8411 "guix gc -F 1G"))
8412
8413 (define idutils-job
8414 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
8415 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
8416 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
8417 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
8418 #:user "charlie"))
8419
8420 (operating-system
8421 ;; @dots{}
8422 (services (cons (mcron-service (list garbage-collector-job
8423 updatedb-job
8424 idutils-job))
8425 %base-services)))
8426 @end lisp
8427
8428 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
8429 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
8430 reference of the mcron service.
8431
8432 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mcron-service @var{jobs} [#:mcron @var{mcron2}]
8433 Return an mcron service running @var{mcron} that schedules @var{jobs}, a
8434 list of gexps denoting mcron job specifications.
8435
8436 This is a shorthand for:
8437 @example
8438 (service mcron-service-type
8439 (mcron-configuration (mcron mcron) (jobs jobs)))
8440 @end example
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
8444 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
8445 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
8446
8447 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
8448 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
8449 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
8450 mcron jobs to run.
8451 @end defvr
8452
8453 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
8454 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
8455
8456 @table @asis
8457 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron2})
8458 The mcron package to use.
8459
8460 @item @code{jobs}
8461 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
8462 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
8463 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
8464 @end table
8465 @end deftp
8466
8467
8468 @node Log Rotation
8469 @subsubsection Log Rotation
8470
8471 @cindex rottlog
8472 @cindex log rotation
8473 @cindex logging
8474 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
8475 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
8476 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
8477 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
8478 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
8479
8480 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
8481 with the default settings.
8482
8483 @lisp
8484 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
8485 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
8486 (use-package-modules base idutils)
8487
8488 (operating-system
8489 ;; @dots{}
8490 (services (cons* (mcron-service)
8491 (service rottlog-service-type (rottlog-configuration))
8492 %base-services)))
8493 @end lisp
8494
8495 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
8496 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
8497 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
8498
8499 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
8500 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
8501 @end defvr
8502
8503 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
8504 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
8505
8506 @table @asis
8507 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
8508 The Rottlog package to use.
8509
8510 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
8511 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
8512 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
8513
8514 @item @code{periodic-rotations} (default: @code{`(("weekly" %default-rotatations))})
8515 A list of Rottlog period-name/period-config tuples.
8516
8517 For example, taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period
8518 Related File Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a valid tuple
8519 might be:
8520
8521 @example
8522 ("daily" ,(plain-file "daily"
8523 "\
8524 /var/log/apache/* @{
8525 storedir apache-archives
8526 rotate 6
8527 notifempty
8528 nocompress
8529 @}"))
8530 @end example
8531
8532 @item @code{jobs}
8533 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
8534 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
8535 @end table
8536 @end deftp
8537
8538 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
8539 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
8540 @code{"/var/log/shepherd.log"}.
8541 @end defvr
8542
8543 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
8544 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
8545 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
8546 @end defvr
8547
8548 @node Networking Services
8549 @subsubsection Networking Services
8550
8551 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
8552 the network interface.
8553
8554 @cindex DHCP, networking service
8555 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
8556 Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
8557 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
8561 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}]
8562 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
8563 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
8564 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway.
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @cindex wicd
8568 @cindex wireless
8569 @cindex WiFi
8570 @cindex network management
8571 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
8572 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
8573 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
8574
8575 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
8576 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
8577 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
8578 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
8579 @end deffn
8580
8581 @cindex NetworkManager
8582 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
8583 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
8584 Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
8585 attempting to keep network connectivity active when available.
8586 @end deffn
8587
8588 @cindex Connman
8589 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} connman-service @
8590 [#:connman @var{connman}]
8591 Return a service that runs @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman}, a network
8592 connection manager.
8593
8594 This service adds the @var{connman} package to the global profile, providing
8595 several the @command{connmanctl} command to interact with the daemon and
8596 configure networking."
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @cindex WPA Supplicant
8600 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
8601 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
8602 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
8603 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks. It is configured to listen for
8604 requests on D-Bus.
8605
8606 The value of this service is the @code{wpa-supplicant} package to use.
8607 Thus, it can be instantiated like this:
8608
8609 @lisp
8610 (use-modules (gnu services networking)
8611 (gnu packages admin))
8612
8613 (service wpa-supplicant-service-type wpa-supplicant)
8614 @end lisp
8615 @end defvr
8616
8617 @cindex NTP
8618 @cindex real time clock
8619 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
8620 [#:servers @var{%ntp-servers}] @
8621 [#:allow-large-adjustment? #f]
8622 Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
8623 @uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
8624 keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
8625 @var{allow-large-adjustment?} determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to
8626 make an initial adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
8627 @end deffn
8628
8629 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
8630 List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
8631 @end defvr
8632
8633 @cindex Tor
8634 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
8635 Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
8636 networking daemon.
8637
8638 The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
8639 @var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
8640 and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
8641 @command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @cindex hidden service
8645 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
8646 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
8647 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
8648
8649 @example
8650 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
8651 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
8652 @end example
8653
8654 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
8655 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
8656
8657 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
8658 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
8659 service.
8660
8661 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
8662 project's documentation} for more information.
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
8666 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
8667 [#:extra-settings ""]
8668 Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
8669 acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
8670
8671 The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
8672 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
8673 local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
8674 come from any networking interface.
8675
8676 In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
8677 configuration file.
8678 @end deffn
8679
8680 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
8681 @cindex SSH
8682 @cindex SSH server
8683
8684 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
8685 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
8686 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
8687 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
8688 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
8689 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
8690 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
8691 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
8692 only by root.
8693
8694 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
8695 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
8696 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
8697 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
8698 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
8699
8700 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
8701 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
8702 require interaction.
8703
8704 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
8705 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
8706 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
8707 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
8708
8709 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
8710 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
8711 or addresses.
8712
8713 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
8714 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
8715 root.
8716
8717 The other options should be self-descriptive.
8718 @end deffn
8719
8720 @cindex SSH
8721 @cindex SSH server
8722 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
8723 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
8724 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
8725 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
8726
8727 @example
8728 (service openssh-service-type
8729 (openssh-configuration
8730 (x11-forwarding? #t)
8731 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
8732 @end example
8733
8734 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
8738 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
8739
8740 @table @asis
8741 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
8742 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
8743
8744 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
8745 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
8746
8747 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
8748 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
8749 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
8750 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
8751 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
8752
8753 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8754 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
8755 not.
8756
8757 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8758 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
8759 other authentication methods.
8760
8761 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8762 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
8763 false, users have to use other authentication method.
8764
8765 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
8766 This is used only by protocol version 2.
8767
8768 @item @code{rsa-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8769 When true, users may log in using pure RSA authentication. When false,
8770 users have to use other means of authentication. This is used only by
8771 protocol 1.
8772
8773 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
8774 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
8775 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
8776 @option{-Y} will work.
8777
8778 @item @code{protocol-number} (default: @code{2})
8779 The SSH protocol number to use.
8780 @end table
8781 @end deftp
8782
8783 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
8784 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
8785 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
8786 object.
8787
8788 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
8789 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
8790
8791 @example
8792 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
8793 (port-number 1234)))
8794 @end example
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
8798 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
8799
8800 @table @asis
8801 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
8802 The Dropbear package to use.
8803
8804 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
8805 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
8806
8807 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
8808 Whether to enable syslog output.
8809
8810 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
8811 File name of the daemon's PID file.
8812
8813 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
8814 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
8815
8816 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8817 Whether to allow empty passwords.
8818
8819 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8820 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
8821 @end table
8822 @end deftp
8823
8824 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
8825 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
8826 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
8827 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
8828 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
8829 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
8830
8831 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
8832 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
8833 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
8834
8835 @example
8836 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
8837
8838 (operating-system
8839 (host-name "mymachine")
8840 ;; ...
8841 (hosts-file
8842 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
8843 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
8844 (plain-file "hosts"
8845 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
8846 %facebook-host-aliases))))
8847 @end example
8848
8849 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
8850 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
8851 @end defvr
8852
8853 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
8854
8855 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
8856 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
8857 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
8858 [#:domains-to-browse '()] [#:debug? #f]
8859 Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
8860 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
8861 "zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
8862 extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
8863 @code{.local} host names using
8864 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
8865 add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
8866 @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
8867
8868 If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
8869 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
8870
8871 When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
8872 in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
8873 address via mDNS on the local network.
8874
8875 When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
8876
8877 Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
8878 sockets.
8879 @end deffn
8880
8881
8882 @node X Window
8883 @subsubsection X Window
8884
8885 @cindex X11
8886 @cindex X Window System
8887 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
8888 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
8889 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
8890 started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
8891
8892 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
8893 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
8894
8895 @table @asis
8896 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
8897 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
8898 or "wayland".
8899
8900 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
8901 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
8902
8903 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
8904 Command to run when halting.
8905
8906 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
8907 Command to run when rebooting.
8908
8909 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
8910 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
8911
8912 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
8913 Directory to look for themes.
8914
8915 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
8916 Directory to look for faces.
8917
8918 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
8919 Default PATH to use.
8920
8921 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default 1000)
8922 Minimum UID to display in SDDM.
8923
8924 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default 2000)
8925 Maximum UID to display in SDDM
8926
8927 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
8928 Remember last user.
8929
8930 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
8931 Remember last session.
8932
8933 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
8934 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
8935
8936 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
8937 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
8938
8939 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
8940 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
8941
8942 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
8943 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
8944
8945 @item @code{xorg-server-path} (default @code{xorg-start-command})
8946 Path to xorg-server.
8947
8948 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
8949 Path to xauth.
8950
8951 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
8952 Path to Xephyr.
8953
8954 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
8955 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
8956
8957 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
8958 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
8959
8960 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitr })
8961 Script to run before starting a X session.
8962
8963 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
8964 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
8965
8966 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
8967 Minimum VT to use.
8968
8969 @item @code{xserver-arguments} (default "-nolisten tcp")
8970 Arguments to pass to xorg-server.
8971
8972 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
8973 User to use for auto-login.
8974
8975 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
8976 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
8977
8978 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
8979 Relogin after logout.
8980
8981 @end table
8982 @end deftp
8983
8984 @cindex login manager
8985 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
8986 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
8987 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
8988
8989 @example
8990 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
8991 (auto-login-user "Alice")
8992 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
8993 @end example
8994 @end deffn
8995
8996 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
8997 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
8998 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
8999 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
9000 Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
9001 turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
9002 @code{xorg-start-command}.
9003
9004 @cindex X session
9005
9006 SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
9007 files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
9008 to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
9009 @var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
9010 adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
9011 available at the log-in screen.
9012
9013 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
9014 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
9015 and/or other X clients.
9016
9017 When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
9018 password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
9019 @var{default-user}.
9020
9021 If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, use the default log-in theme; otherwise
9022 @var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
9023 theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
9024 theme.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9028 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
9029 The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
9030 @end defvr
9031
9032 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
9033 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
9034 Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
9035 from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
9036 file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
9037 @code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
9038
9039 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
9040 @end deffn
9041
9042 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
9043 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
9044 Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
9045 all the common drivers.
9046
9047 @var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
9048 graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
9049 this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
9050
9051 Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
9052 appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
9053 resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
9054
9055 Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
9056 @code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
9057 verbatim to the configuration file.
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
9061 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
9062 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
9063 for it. For example:
9064
9065 @lisp
9066 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
9067 @end lisp
9068
9069 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
9070 @end deffn
9071
9072
9073 @node Printing Services
9074 @subsubsection Printing Services
9075
9076 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
9077 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a GuixSD
9078 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
9079
9080 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
9081 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
9082 CUPS configuration (see below). For example:
9083 @example
9084 (service cups-service-type (cups-configuration))
9085 @end example
9086 @end deffn
9087
9088 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
9089 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
9090 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
9091 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
9092 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
9093 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
9094 secure connections to the print server.
9095
9096 One way you might want to customize CUPS is to enable or disable the web
9097 interface. You can do that directly, like this:
9098
9099 @example
9100 (service cups-service-type
9101 (cups-configuration
9102 (web-interface? #f)))
9103 @end example
9104
9105 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
9106 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
9107 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
9108 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
9109 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
9110 from some other system; see the end for more details.
9111
9112 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
9113 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
9114 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
9115 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
9116 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
9117 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
9118 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
9119
9120
9121 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
9122
9123 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
9124 The CUPS package.
9125 @end deftypevr
9126
9127 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
9128 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
9129 @end deftypevr
9130
9131 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
9132 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
9133 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
9134
9135 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
9136
9137 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
9138 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9139 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9140 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9141 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9142 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9143 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9144 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
9145
9146 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
9147 @end deftypevr
9148
9149 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
9150 Where CUPS should cache data.
9151
9152 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
9153 @end deftypevr
9154
9155 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
9156 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
9157 writes.
9158
9159 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
9160 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
9161 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
9162 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
9163 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
9164
9165 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
9166 @end deftypevr
9167
9168 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
9169 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9170 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9171 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9172 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9173 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9174 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9175 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
9176
9177 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
9178 @end deftypevr
9179
9180 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
9181 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
9182 kind strings are:
9183
9184 @table @code
9185 @item none
9186 No errors are fatal.
9187
9188 @item all
9189 All of the errors below are fatal.
9190
9191 @item browse
9192 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
9193 to the DNS-SD daemon.
9194
9195 @item config
9196 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
9197
9198 @item listen
9199 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
9200 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
9201
9202 @item log
9203 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
9204
9205 @item permissions
9206 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
9207 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
9208 @end table
9209
9210 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
9211 @end deftypevr
9212
9213 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
9214 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
9215 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
9216
9217 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9218 @end deftypevr
9219
9220 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
9221 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
9222 programs.
9223
9224 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
9225 @end deftypevr
9226
9227 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
9228 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
9229
9230 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
9231 @end deftypevr
9232
9233 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
9234 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9235 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9236 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9237 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9238 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9239 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9240 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
9241
9242 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
9243 @end deftypevr
9244
9245 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
9246 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
9247 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
9248
9249 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
9250 @end deftypevr
9251
9252 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
9253 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
9254 data.
9255
9256 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
9257 @end deftypevr
9258
9259 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
9260 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
9261 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
9262 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
9263 used/supported on macOS.
9264
9265 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
9266 @end deftypevr
9267
9268 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
9269 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
9270 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
9271 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
9272 PEM-encoded private keys.
9273
9274 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
9275 @end deftypevr
9276
9277 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
9278 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
9279
9280 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
9281 @end deftypevr
9282
9283 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
9284 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
9285 configuration or state files.
9286
9287 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9288 @end deftypevr
9289
9290 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
9291 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
9292 @end deftypevr
9293
9294 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
9295 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
9296
9297 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
9298 @end deftypevr
9299
9300 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
9301 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
9302 programs.
9303
9304 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
9305 @end deftypevr
9306 @end deftypevr
9307
9308 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
9309 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
9310 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
9311 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
9312 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
9313 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
9314 level logs all requests.
9315
9316 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
9317 @end deftypevr
9318
9319 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
9320 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
9321 longer required for quotas.
9322
9323 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9324 @end deftypevr
9325
9326 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
9327 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
9328
9329 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
9330 @end deftypevr
9331
9332 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
9333 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
9334
9335 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9336 @end deftypevr
9337
9338 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
9339 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
9340
9341 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9342 @end deftypevr
9343
9344 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
9345 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
9346 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
9347 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
9348 secure printing functions.
9349
9350 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9351 @end deftypevr
9352
9353 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
9354 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
9355 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
9356
9357 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9358 @end deftypevr
9359
9360 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
9361 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
9362
9363 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
9364 @end deftypevr
9365
9366 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
9367 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
9368
9369 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
9370 @end deftypevr
9371
9372 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
9373 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
9374
9375 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
9376 @end deftypevr
9377
9378 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
9379 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
9380 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
9381 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
9382 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
9383
9384 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
9385 @end deftypevr
9386
9387 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
9388 Specifies the default access policy to use.
9389
9390 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
9391 @end deftypevr
9392
9393 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
9394 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
9395
9396 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9397 @end deftypevr
9398
9399 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
9400 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
9401 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
9402 typically within a few milliseconds.
9403
9404 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9405 @end deftypevr
9406
9407 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
9408 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
9409 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
9410 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
9411 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
9412 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
9413
9414 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
9415 @end deftypevr
9416
9417 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
9418 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
9419 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
9420 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
9421 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
9422 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
9423 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
9424 at any time.
9425
9426 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9427 @end deftypevr
9428
9429 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
9430 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
9431 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
9432 lowest priority.
9433
9434 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9435 @end deftypevr
9436
9437 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
9438 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
9439 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
9440 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
9441 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
9442 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
9443 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
9444
9445 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9446 @end deftypevr
9447
9448 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
9449 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
9450 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
9451
9452 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9453 @end deftypevr
9454
9455 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
9456 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
9457 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
9458 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
9459 @code{retry-current-job}.
9460
9461 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9462 @end deftypevr
9463
9464 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
9465 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
9466 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
9467 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
9468 @code{retry-current-job}.
9469
9470 Defaults to @samp{5}.
9471 @end deftypevr
9472
9473 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
9474 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
9475
9476 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9477 @end deftypevr
9478
9479 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
9480 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
9481
9482 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9483 @end deftypevr
9484
9485 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
9486 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
9487 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
9488
9489 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9490 @end deftypevr
9491
9492 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
9493 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
9494 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
9495 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
9496 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
9497 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
9498 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
9499 @end deftypevr
9500
9501 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
9502 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
9503 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
9504 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
9505 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
9506 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
9507 ones.
9508
9509 Defaults to @samp{128}.
9510 @end deftypevr
9511
9512 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
9513 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
9514
9515 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
9516
9517 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
9518 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
9519 @end deftypevr
9520
9521 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
9522 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
9523 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
9524
9525 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9526 @end deftypevr
9527
9528 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
9529 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
9530
9531 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9532
9533 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
9534
9535 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
9536 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
9537 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
9538
9539 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9540 @end deftypevr
9541
9542 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
9543 Methods to which this access control applies.
9544
9545 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9546 @end deftypevr
9547
9548 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
9549 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
9550 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
9551
9552 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9553 @end deftypevr
9554 @end deftypevr
9555 @end deftypevr
9556
9557 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
9558 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
9559 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
9560 of the LogLevel setting.
9561
9562 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9563 @end deftypevr
9564
9565 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
9566 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
9567 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
9568
9569 Defaults to @samp{info}.
9570 @end deftypevr
9571
9572 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
9573 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
9574 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
9575
9576 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
9577 @end deftypevr
9578
9579 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
9580 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
9581 the scheduler.
9582
9583 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9584 @end deftypevr
9585
9586 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
9587 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
9588 from a single address.
9589
9590 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9591 @end deftypevr
9592
9593 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
9594 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
9595 job.
9596
9597 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
9598 @end deftypevr
9599
9600 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
9601 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
9602 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
9603 held jobs.
9604
9605 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9606 @end deftypevr
9607
9608 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
9609 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
9610 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
9611
9612 Defaults to @samp{500}.
9613 @end deftypevr
9614
9615 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
9616 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
9617 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
9618
9619 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9620 @end deftypevr
9621
9622 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
9623 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
9624 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
9625
9626 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9627 @end deftypevr
9628
9629 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
9630 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
9631 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
9632
9633 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
9634 @end deftypevr
9635
9636 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
9637 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
9638 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
9639
9640 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
9641 @end deftypevr
9642
9643 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
9644 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
9645 multiple file print job, in seconds.
9646
9647 Defaults to @samp{300}.
9648 @end deftypevr
9649
9650 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
9651 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
9652 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
9653 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
9654 sequences are recognized:
9655
9656 @table @samp
9657 @item %%
9658 insert a single percent character
9659
9660 @item %@{name@}
9661 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
9662
9663 @item %C
9664 insert the number of copies for the current page
9665
9666 @item %P
9667 insert the current page number
9668
9669 @item %T
9670 insert the current date and time in common log format
9671
9672 @item %j
9673 insert the job ID
9674
9675 @item %p
9676 insert the printer name
9677
9678 @item %u
9679 insert the username
9680 @end table
9681
9682 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
9683 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
9684 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
9685 standard items.
9686
9687 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9688 @end deftypevr
9689
9690 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
9691 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
9692 of strings.
9693
9694 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9695 @end deftypevr
9696
9697 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
9698 Specifies named access control policies.
9699
9700 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
9701
9702 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
9703 Name of the policy.
9704 @end deftypevr
9705
9706 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
9707 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
9708 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
9709 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
9710 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
9711 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
9712 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
9713 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
9714 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
9715 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
9716
9717 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
9718 @end deftypevr
9719
9720 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
9721 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
9722 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
9723
9724 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
9725 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
9726 @end deftypevr
9727
9728 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
9729 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
9730 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
9731 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
9732 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
9733 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
9734 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
9735 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
9736 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
9737 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
9738
9739 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
9740 @end deftypevr
9741
9742 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
9743 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
9744 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
9745
9746 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
9747 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
9748 @end deftypevr
9749
9750 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
9751 Access control by IPP operation.
9752
9753 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9754 @end deftypevr
9755 @end deftypevr
9756
9757 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
9758 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
9759 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
9760 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
9761 value applies indefinitely.
9762
9763 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
9764 @end deftypevr
9765
9766 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
9767 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
9768 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
9769 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
9770 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
9771
9772 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9773 @end deftypevr
9774
9775 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
9776 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
9777 restarting the scheduler.
9778
9779 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9780 @end deftypevr
9781
9782 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
9783 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
9784 into bitmaps for a printer.
9785
9786 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
9787 @end deftypevr
9788
9789 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
9790 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
9791
9792 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
9793 @end deftypevr
9794
9795 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
9796 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
9797 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
9798 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
9799 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
9800 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
9801 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
9802 @code{*}.
9803
9804 Defaults to @samp{*}.
9805 @end deftypevr
9806
9807 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
9808 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
9809
9810 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
9811 @end deftypevr
9812
9813 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
9814 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
9815 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
9816 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
9817 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
9818 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
9819 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
9820 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
9821
9822 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
9823 @end deftypevr
9824
9825 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
9826 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
9827
9828 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
9829 @end deftypevr
9830
9831 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
9832 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
9833 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
9834 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
9835 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
9836
9837 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9838 @end deftypevr
9839
9840 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
9841 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
9842 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
9843 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
9844 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
9845 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
9846 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
9847
9848 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9849 @end deftypevr
9850
9851 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
9852 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
9853 the IPP specifications.
9854
9855 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9856 @end deftypevr
9857
9858 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
9859 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
9860
9861 Defaults to @samp{300}.
9862
9863 @end deftypevr
9864
9865 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
9866 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
9867
9868 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9869 @end deftypevr
9870
9871 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
9872 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
9873 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
9874 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
9875 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
9876 @code{cups-service-type}.
9877
9878 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
9879
9880 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
9881 The CUPS package.
9882 @end deftypevr
9883
9884 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
9885 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
9886 @end deftypevr
9887
9888 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
9889 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
9890 @end deftypevr
9891
9892 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
9893 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
9894 this:
9895
9896 @example
9897 (service cups-service-type
9898 (opaque-cups-configuration
9899 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
9900 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
9901 @end example
9902
9903
9904 @node Desktop Services
9905 @subsubsection Desktop Services
9906
9907 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
9908 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
9909 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
9910 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
9911 environments like GNOME and XFCE.
9912
9913 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
9914 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
9915 environment and networking:
9916
9917 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
9918 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
9919 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
9920
9921 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
9922 @code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
9923 a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
9924 Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
9925 the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
9926 the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
9927 Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
9928 configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
9929 Switch, mDNS}).
9930 @end defvr
9931
9932 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
9933 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
9934 Reference, @code{services}}).
9935
9936 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service} and
9937 @code{xfce-desktop-service} procedures can add GNOME and/or XFCE to a
9938 system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the
9939 backlight adjustment helpers and the power management utilities are
9940 added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
9941 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
9942 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
9943 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service} adds the GNOME
9944 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the XFCE service
9945 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
9946 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
9947 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
9948 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
9949
9950 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gnome-desktop-service
9951 Return a service that adds the @code{gnome} package to the system
9952 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
9953 @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xfce-desktop-service
9957 Return a service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile,
9958 and extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the
9959 file system as root from within a user session, after the user has
9960 authenticated with the administrator's password.
9961 @end deffn
9962
9963 Because the GNOME and XFCE desktop services pull in so many packages,
9964 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include either of
9965 them by default. To add GNOME or XFCE, just @code{cons} them onto
9966 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
9967 @code{operating-system}:
9968
9969 @example
9970 (use-modules (gnu))
9971 (use-service-modules desktop)
9972 (operating-system
9973 ...
9974 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
9975 (services (cons* (gnome-desktop-service)
9976 (xfce-desktop-service)
9977 %desktop-services))
9978 ...)
9979 @end example
9980
9981 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
9982 graphical login window.
9983
9984 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
9985 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
9986 are described below.
9987
9988 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
9989 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
9990 support for @var{services}.
9991
9992 @uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
9993 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
9994 and to be notified of system-wide events.
9995
9996 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
9997 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
9998 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
9999 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
10003 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
10004 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
10005 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
10006 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
10007 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
10008
10009 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
10010 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
10011 when the power button is pressed.
10012
10013 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
10014 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
10015 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
10016 their default values are:
10017
10018 @table @code
10019 @item kill-user-processes?
10020 @code{#f}
10021 @item kill-only-users
10022 @code{()}
10023 @item kill-exclude-users
10024 @code{("root")}
10025 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
10026 @code{5}
10027 @item handle-power-key
10028 @code{poweroff}
10029 @item handle-suspend-key
10030 @code{suspend}
10031 @item handle-hibernate-key
10032 @code{hibernate}
10033 @item handle-lid-switch
10034 @code{suspend}
10035 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
10036 @code{ignore}
10037 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
10038 @code{#f}
10039 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
10040 @code{#f}
10041 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
10042 @code{#f}
10043 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
10044 @code{#t}
10045 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
10046 @code{30}
10047 @item idle-action
10048 @code{ignore}
10049 @item idle-action-seconds
10050 @code{(* 30 60)}
10051 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
10052 @code{10}
10053 @item runtime-directory-size
10054 @code{#f}
10055 @item remove-ipc?
10056 @code{#t}
10057 @item suspend-state
10058 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
10059 @item suspend-mode
10060 @code{()}
10061 @item hibernate-state
10062 @code{("disk")}
10063 @item hibernate-mode
10064 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
10065 @item hybrid-sleep-state
10066 @code{("disk")}
10067 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
10068 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
10069 @end table
10070 @end deffn
10071
10072 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
10073 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
10074 Return a service that runs the
10075 @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
10076 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
10077 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
10078 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
10079 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
10080 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
10081 @end deffn
10082
10083 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
10084 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
10085 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
10086 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
10087 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
10088 [#:percentage-low 10] @
10089 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
10090 [#:percentage-action 2] @
10091 [#:time-low 1200] @
10092 [#:time-critical 300] @
10093 [#:time-action 120] @
10094 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
10095 Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
10096 @command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
10097 levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
10098 @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
10099 GNOME.
10100 @end deffn
10101
10102 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
10103 Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
10104 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
10105 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
10106 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
10107 @end deffn
10108
10109 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
10110 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
10111 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
10112 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
10113 tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
10114 site} for more information.
10115 @end deffn
10116
10117 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
10118 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
10119 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
10120 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
10121 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
10122 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
10123 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
10124 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
10125 means that all users are allowed.
10126 @end deffn
10127
10128 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
10129 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
10130 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
10131 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
10132 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
10133 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
10134 know the user's location.
10135 @end defvr
10136
10137 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
10138 [#:whitelist '()] @
10139 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
10140 [#:submit-data? #f]
10141 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
10142 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
10143 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
10144 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
10145 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
10146 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
10147 location databases. See
10148 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
10149 web site} for more information.
10150 @end deffn
10151
10152 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}]
10153 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which manages
10154 all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus interfaces.
10155
10156 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @node Database Services
10160 @subsubsection Database Services
10161
10162 @cindex database
10163 @cindex SQL
10164 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
10165
10166 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
10167 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
10168 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
10169 server.
10170
10171 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
10172 @var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
10173 @var{data-directory}.
10174 @end deffn
10175
10176 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
10177 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
10178 database server.
10179
10180 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
10181 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
10185 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
10186
10187 @table @asis
10188 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
10189 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
10190 or @var{mysql}.
10191
10192 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
10193 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
10194
10195 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
10196 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
10197 @end table
10198 @end deftp
10199
10200 @node Mail Services
10201 @subsubsection Mail Services
10202
10203 @cindex mail
10204 @cindex email
10205 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
10206 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
10207 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
10208 in the subsections below.
10209
10210 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
10211
10212 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
10213 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
10214 @end deffn
10215
10216 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
10217 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
10218 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
10219 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
10220 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
10221 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
10222 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
10223 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
10224
10225 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
10226 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
10227
10228 @example
10229 (dovecot-service #:config
10230 (dovecot-configuration
10231 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
10232 @end example
10233
10234 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
10235 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
10236 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
10237 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
10238 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
10239 from some other system; see the end for more details.
10240
10241 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
10242 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
10243 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
10244 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
10245 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
10246 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
10247 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
10248
10249 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
10250
10251 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
10252 The dovecot package.
10253 @end deftypevr
10254
10255 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
10256 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
10257 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
10258 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
10259 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
10260 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
10261 @end deftypevr
10262
10263 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
10264 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
10265 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
10266
10267 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
10268
10269 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
10270 The name of the protocol.
10271 @end deftypevr
10272
10273 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
10274 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
10275 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
10276 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
10277 @end deftypevr
10278
10279 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
10280 Space separated list of plugins to load.
10281 @end deftypevr
10282
10283 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
10284 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
10285 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
10286 Defaults to @samp{10}.
10287 @end deftypevr
10288
10289 @end deftypevr
10290
10291 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
10292 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
10293 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
10294 @samp{lmtp}.
10295
10296 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
10297
10298 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
10299 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
10300 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
10301 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
10302 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
10303 @end deftypevr
10304
10305 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
10306 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
10307 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
10308 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
10309 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10310
10311 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
10312
10313 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
10314 The file name on which to listen.
10315 @end deftypevr
10316
10317 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
10318 The access mode for the socket.
10319 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
10320 @end deftypevr
10321
10322 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
10323 The user to own the socket.
10324 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10325 @end deftypevr
10326
10327 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
10328 The group to own the socket.
10329 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10330 @end deftypevr
10331
10332
10333 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
10334
10335 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
10336 The file name on which to listen.
10337 @end deftypevr
10338
10339 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
10340 The access mode for the socket.
10341 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
10342 @end deftypevr
10343
10344 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
10345 The user to own the socket.
10346 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10347 @end deftypevr
10348
10349 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
10350 The group to own the socket.
10351 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10352 @end deftypevr
10353
10354
10355 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
10356
10357 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
10358 The protocol to listen for.
10359 @end deftypevr
10360
10361 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
10362 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
10363 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10364 @end deftypevr
10365
10366 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
10367 The port on which to listen.
10368 @end deftypevr
10369
10370 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
10371 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
10372 @samp{required}.
10373 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10374 @end deftypevr
10375
10376 @end deftypevr
10377
10378 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
10379 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
10380 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
10381 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
10382 Defaults to @samp{1}.
10383 @end deftypevr
10384
10385 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
10386 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
10387 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10388 @end deftypevr
10389
10390 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
10391 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
10392 this.
10393 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
10394 @end deftypevr
10395
10396 @end deftypevr
10397
10398 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
10399 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
10400 constructor.
10401
10402 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
10403
10404 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
10405 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
10406 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10407 @end deftypevr
10408
10409 @end deftypevr
10410
10411 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
10412 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
10413 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
10414
10415 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
10416
10417 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
10418 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
10419 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
10420 @samp{static}.
10421 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
10422 @end deftypevr
10423
10424 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
10425 A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
10426 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10427 @end deftypevr
10428
10429 @end deftypevr
10430
10431 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
10432 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
10433 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
10434
10435 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
10436
10437 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
10438 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
10439 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
10440 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
10441 @end deftypevr
10442
10443 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
10444 A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
10445 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10446 @end deftypevr
10447
10448 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
10449 Override fields from passwd.
10450 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10451 @end deftypevr
10452
10453 @end deftypevr
10454
10455 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
10456 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
10457 constructor.
10458 @end deftypevr
10459
10460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
10461 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
10462 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
10463
10464 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
10465
10466 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
10467 Name for this namespace.
10468 @end deftypevr
10469
10470 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
10471 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
10472 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
10473 @end deftypevr
10474
10475 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
10476 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
10477 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
10478 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
10479 format.
10480 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10481 @end deftypevr
10482
10483 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
10484 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
10485 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
10486 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10487 @end deftypevr
10488
10489 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
10490 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
10491 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
10492 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10493 @end deftypevr
10494
10495 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
10496 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
10497 namespace has it.
10498 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10499 @end deftypevr
10500
10501 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
10502 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
10503 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
10504 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
10505 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
10506 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
10507 and @samp{mail/}.
10508 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10509 @end deftypevr
10510
10511 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
10512 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
10513 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
10514 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
10515 hides the namespace prefix.
10516 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10517 @end deftypevr
10518
10519 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
10520 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
10521 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
10522 as @code{#t}).
10523 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10524 @end deftypevr
10525
10526 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
10527 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
10528 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10529
10530 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
10531
10532 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
10533 Name for this mailbox.
10534 @end deftypevr
10535
10536 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
10537 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
10538 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
10539 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
10540 @end deftypevr
10541
10542 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
10543 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
10544 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
10545 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
10546 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10547 @end deftypevr
10548
10549 @end deftypevr
10550
10551 @end deftypevr
10552
10553 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
10554 Base directory where to store runtime data.
10555 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
10556 @end deftypevr
10557
10558 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
10559 Greeting message for clients.
10560 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
10561 @end deftypevr
10562
10563 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
10564 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
10565 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
10566 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
10567 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
10568 here.
10569 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10570 @end deftypevr
10571
10572 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
10573 List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
10574 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10575 @end deftypevr
10576
10577 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
10578 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
10579 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
10580 processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
10581 accounts).
10582 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10583 @end deftypevr
10584
10585 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
10586 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
10587 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
10588 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
10589 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. due to a security fix).
10590 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10591 @end deftypevr
10592
10593 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
10594 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
10595 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
10596 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10597 @end deftypevr
10598
10599 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
10600 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
10601 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
10602 @end deftypevr
10603
10604 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
10605 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
10606 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
10607 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
10608 @end deftypevr
10609
10610 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
10611 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
10612 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
10613 matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
10614 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
10615 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
10616 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10617 @end deftypevr
10618
10619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
10620 Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
10621 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
10622 for caching to be used.
10623 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10624 @end deftypevr
10625
10626 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
10627 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
10628 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
10629 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
10630 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
10631 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
10632 authentication.
10633 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
10634 @end deftypevr
10635
10636 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
10637 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
10638 0 disables caching them completely.
10639 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
10640 @end deftypevr
10641
10642 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
10643 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
10644 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
10645 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
10646 realm first.
10647 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10648 @end deftypevr
10649
10650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
10651 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
10652 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
10653 logins.
10654 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10655 @end deftypevr
10656
10657 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
10658 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
10659 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
10660 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
10661 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
10662 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
10663 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
10664 @end deftypevr
10665
10666 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
10667 Username character translations before it's looked up from
10668 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
10669 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
10670 translated to @samp{@@}.
10671 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10672 @end deftypevr
10673
10674 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
10675 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
10676 use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
10677 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
10678 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
10679 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
10680 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
10681 @end deftypevr
10682
10683 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
10684 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
10685 username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
10686 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
10687 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
10688 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
10689 choice.
10690 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10691 @end deftypevr
10692
10693 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
10694 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
10695 mechanism.
10696 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
10697 @end deftypevr
10698
10699 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
10700 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
10701 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
10702 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
10703 Defaults to @samp{30}.
10704 @end deftypevr
10705
10706 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
10707 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
10708 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
10709 allow all keytab entries.
10710 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10711 @end deftypevr
10712
10713 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
10714 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
10715 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
10716 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
10717 file.
10718 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10719 @end deftypevr
10720
10721 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
10722 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
10723 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
10724 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
10725 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10726 @end deftypevr
10727
10728 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
10729 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
10730 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
10731 @end deftypevr
10732
10733 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
10734 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
10735 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
10736 @end deftypevr
10737
10738 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
10739 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
10740 fails.
10741 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10742 @end deftypevr
10743
10744 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
10745 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
10746 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
10747 CommonName.
10748 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10749 @end deftypevr
10750
10751 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
10752 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
10753 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
10754 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
10755 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
10756 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
10757 @end deftypevr
10758
10759 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
10760 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
10761 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
10762 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
10763 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10764 @end deftypevr
10765
10766 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
10767 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
10768 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
10769 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10770 @end deftypevr
10771
10772 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
10773 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
10774 has any connections.
10775 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
10776 @end deftypevr
10777
10778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
10779 TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
10780 connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
10781 @samp{inet-listener} for the port.
10782 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10783 @end deftypevr
10784
10785 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
10786 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
10787 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
10788 are shared within domain.
10789 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
10790 @end deftypevr
10791
10792 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
10793 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
10794 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
10795 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
10796 @end deftypevr
10797
10798 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
10799 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
10800 @samp{log-path}.
10801 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10802 @end deftypevr
10803
10804 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
10805 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
10806 @samp{info-log-path}.
10807 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10808 @end deftypevr
10809
10810 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
10811 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
10812 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
10813 standard facilities are supported.
10814 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
10815 @end deftypevr
10816
10817 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
10818 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
10819 failed.
10820 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10821 @end deftypevr
10822
10823 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
10824 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
10825 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
10826 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
10827 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
10828 ":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
10829 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10830 @end deftypevr
10831
10832 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
10833 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
10834 SQL queries.
10835 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10836 @end deftypevr
10837
10838 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
10839 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
10840 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
10841 @samp{auth-debug}.
10842 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10843 @end deftypevr
10844
10845 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
10846 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
10847 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
10848 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10849 @end deftypevr
10850
10851 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
10852 Show protocol level SSL errors.
10853 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10854 @end deftypevr
10855
10856 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
10857 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
10858 strftime(3) format.
10859 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
10860 @end deftypevr
10861
10862 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
10863 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
10864 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
10865 string.
10866 @end deftypevr
10867
10868 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
10869 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
10870 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
10871 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
10872 @end deftypevr
10873
10874 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
10875 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
10876 of possible variables you can use.
10877 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
10878 @end deftypevr
10879
10880 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
10881 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
10882 @table @code
10883 @item %$
10884 Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
10885 @item %m
10886 Message-ID
10887 @item %s
10888 Subject
10889 @item %f
10890 From address
10891 @item %p
10892 Physical size
10893 @item %w
10894 Virtual size.
10895 @end table
10896 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
10897 @end deftypevr
10898
10899 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
10900 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
10901 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
10902 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
10903 Dovecot the full location.
10904
10905 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
10906 file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
10907 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
10908 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
10909 @samp{mail-location} setting.
10910
10911 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
10912
10913 @table @samp
10914 @item %u
10915 username
10916 @item %n
10917 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
10918 @item %d
10919 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
10920 @item %h
10921 home director
10922 @end table
10923
10924 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
10925 @table @samp
10926 @item maildir:~/Maildir
10927 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
10928 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
10929 @end table
10930 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10931 @end deftypevr
10932
10933 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
10934 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
10935 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
10936 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
10937 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10938 @end deftypevr
10939
10940 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
10941
10942 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10943 @end deftypevr
10944
10945 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
10946 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
10947 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
10948 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
10949 /var/mail.
10950 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10951 @end deftypevr
10952
10953 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
10954 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
10955 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
10956 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
10957 symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
10958 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
10959 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
10960 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10961 @end deftypevr
10962
10963 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
10964 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
10965 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
10966 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
10967 names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
10968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10969 @end deftypevr
10970
10971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
10972 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
10973 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
10974 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10975 @end deftypevr
10976
10977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
10978 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
10979 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
10980 nowadays by default.
10981 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10982 @end deftypevr
10983
10984 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
10985 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
10986 @table @code
10987 @item optimized
10988 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
10989 @item always
10990 Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
10991 @item never
10992 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
10993 @end table
10994 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
10995 @end deftypevr
10996
10997 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
10998 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
10999 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
11000 this isn't needed.
11001 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11002 @end deftypevr
11003
11004 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
11005 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
11006 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
11007 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11008 @end deftypevr
11009
11010 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
11011 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
11012 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
11013 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
11014 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
11015 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
11016 @end deftypevr
11017
11018 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
11019 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
11020 kB.
11021 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
11022 @end deftypevr
11023
11024 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
11025 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
11026 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
11027 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
11028 is set to 0.
11029 Defaults to @samp{500}.
11030 @end deftypevr
11031
11032 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
11033
11034 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11035 @end deftypevr
11036
11037 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
11038 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
11039 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
11040 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
11041 Defaults to @samp{1}.
11042 @end deftypevr
11043
11044 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
11045
11046 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11047 @end deftypevr
11048
11049 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
11050 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
11051 trying to create new keywords.
11052 Defaults to @samp{50}.
11053 @end deftypevr
11054
11055 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
11056 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
11057 processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
11058 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
11059 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
11060 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
11061 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
11062 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
11063 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
11064 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11065 @end deftypevr
11066
11067 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
11068 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
11069 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
11070 directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
11071 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
11072 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
11073 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
11074 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
11075 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11076 @end deftypevr
11077
11078 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
11079 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
11080 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
11081 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
11082 @end deftypevr
11083
11084 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
11085 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
11086 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
11087 @end deftypevr
11088
11089 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
11090 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
11091 LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
11092 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11093 @end deftypevr
11094
11095 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
11096 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
11097 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
11098 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
11099 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11100 @end deftypevr
11101
11102 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
11103 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
11104 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
11105 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
11106 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
11107 occur.
11108 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
11109 @end deftypevr
11110
11111 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
11112 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
11113 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
11114 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
11115 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
11116 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
11117 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11118 @end deftypevr
11119
11120 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
11121 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
11122 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
11123 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
11124 causes more disk I/O.
11125 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
11126 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
11127 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11128 @end deftypevr
11129
11130 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
11131 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
11132 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
11133 side effects.
11134 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11135 @end deftypevr
11136
11137 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
11138 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
11139 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
11140 the mail otherwise.
11141 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11142 @end deftypevr
11143
11144 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
11145 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
11146 available:
11147
11148 @table @code
11149 @item dotlock
11150 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
11151 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
11152 need write access to that directory.
11153 @item dotlock-try
11154 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
11155 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
11156 @item fcntl
11157 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
11158 @item flock
11159 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
11160 @item lockf
11161 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
11162 @end table
11163
11164 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
11165 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
11166 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
11167 them simultaneously.
11168 @end deftypevr
11169
11170 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
11171
11172 @end deftypevr
11173
11174 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
11175 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
11176 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
11177 @end deftypevr
11178
11179 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
11180 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
11181 override the lock file after this much time.
11182 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
11183 @end deftypevr
11184
11185 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
11186 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
11187 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
11188 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
11189 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
11190 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
11191 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
11192 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
11193 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
11194 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
11195 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11196 @end deftypevr
11197
11198 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
11199 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
11200 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
11201 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
11202 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11203 @end deftypevr
11204
11205 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
11206 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
11207 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
11208 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
11209 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
11210 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11211 @end deftypevr
11212
11213 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
11214 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
11215 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
11216 updated.
11217 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11218 @end deftypevr
11219
11220 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
11221 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
11222 Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
11223 @end deftypevr
11224
11225 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
11226 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
11227 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
11228 disabled.
11229 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
11230 @end deftypevr
11231
11232 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
11233 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
11234 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
11235 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
11236 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11237 @end deftypevr
11238
11239 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
11240 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
11241 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
11242 don't support this for now.
11243
11244 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
11245
11246 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
11247 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11248 @end deftypevr
11249
11250 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
11251 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
11252 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
11253 externally.
11254 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
11255 @end deftypevr
11256
11257 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
11258 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
11259 @table @code
11260 @item posix
11261 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
11262 @item sis posix
11263 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
11264 @item sis-queue posix
11265 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
11266 @end table
11267 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
11268 @end deftypevr
11269
11270 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
11271 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
11272 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
11273 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
11274 truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
11275 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
11276 @end deftypevr
11277
11278 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
11279
11280 Defaults to @samp{100}.
11281 @end deftypevr
11282
11283 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
11284
11285 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
11286 @end deftypevr
11287
11288 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
11289 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
11290 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
11291 before they eat up everything.
11292 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
11293 @end deftypevr
11294
11295 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
11296 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
11297 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
11298 at all.
11299 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
11300 @end deftypevr
11301
11302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
11303 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
11304 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
11305 processes.
11306 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
11307 @end deftypevr
11308
11309 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
11310 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
11311 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
11312 @end deftypevr
11313
11314 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
11315 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
11316 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
11317 @end deftypevr
11318
11319 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
11320 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
11321 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
11322 root.
11323 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
11324 @end deftypevr
11325
11326 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
11327 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
11328 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
11329 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
11330 instead to a different.
11331 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11332 @end deftypevr
11333
11334 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
11335 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
11336 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
11337 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
11338 CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
11339 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11340 @end deftypevr
11341
11342 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
11343 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
11344 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11345 @end deftypevr
11346
11347 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
11348 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
11349 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
11350 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11351 @end deftypevr
11352
11353 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
11354 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
11355 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
11356 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
11357 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
11358 @end deftypevr
11359
11360 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
11361 How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
11362 quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
11363 regeneration entirely.
11364 Defaults to @samp{168}.
11365 @end deftypevr
11366
11367 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
11368 SSL protocols to use.
11369 Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
11370 @end deftypevr
11371
11372 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
11373 SSL ciphers to use.
11374 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
11375 @end deftypevr
11376
11377 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
11378 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
11379 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11380 @end deftypevr
11381
11382 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
11383 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
11384 %d expands to recipient domain.
11385 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
11386 @end deftypevr
11387
11388 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
11389 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
11390 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
11391 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11392 @end deftypevr
11393
11394 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
11395 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
11396 bouncing the mail.
11397 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11398 @end deftypevr
11399
11400 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
11401 Binary to use for sending mails.
11402 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
11403 @end deftypevr
11404
11405 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
11406 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
11407 sendmail.
11408 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11409 @end deftypevr
11410
11411 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
11412 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
11413 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
11414 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
11415 @end deftypevr
11416
11417 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
11418 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
11419 variables:
11420
11421 @table @code
11422 @item %n
11423 CRLF
11424 @item %r
11425 reason
11426 @item %s
11427 original subject
11428 @item %t
11429 recipient
11430 @end table
11431 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
11432 @end deftypevr
11433
11434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
11435 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
11436 address.
11437 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
11438 @end deftypevr
11439
11440 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
11441 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
11442 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
11443 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
11444 X-Original-To.
11445 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11446 @end deftypevr
11447
11448 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
11449 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
11450 it?.
11451 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11452 @end deftypevr
11453
11454 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
11455 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
11456 subscribed?.
11457 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11458 @end deftypevr
11459
11460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
11461 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
11462 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
11463 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
11464 often.
11465 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
11466 @end deftypevr
11467
11468 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
11469 IMAP logout format string:
11470 @table @code
11471 @item %i
11472 total number of bytes read from client
11473 @item %o
11474 total number of bytes sent to client.
11475 @end table
11476 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
11477 @end deftypevr
11478
11479 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
11480 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
11481 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
11482 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11483 @end deftypevr
11484
11485 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
11486 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
11487 is IDLEing.
11488 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
11489 @end deftypevr
11490
11491 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
11492 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
11493 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
11494 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
11495 support-email.
11496 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11497 @end deftypevr
11498
11499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
11500 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
11501 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11502 @end deftypevr
11503
11504 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
11505 Workarounds for various client bugs:
11506
11507 @table @code
11508 @item delay-newmail
11509 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
11510 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
11511 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
11512 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
11513 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
11514 "Headers Only".
11515
11516 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
11517 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
11518 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
11519 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
11520
11521 @item tb-lsub-flags
11522 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
11523 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
11524 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
11525 @end table
11526 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11527 @end deftypevr
11528
11529 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
11530 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
11531 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11532 @end deftypevr
11533
11534
11535 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
11536 that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
11537 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
11538 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
11539 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
11540
11541 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
11542 and running. In that case, you can pass an
11543 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
11544 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
11545 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
11546
11547 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
11548
11549 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
11550 The dovecot package.
11551 @end deftypevr
11552
11553 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
11554 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
11555 @end deftypevr
11556
11557 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
11558 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
11559
11560 @example
11561 (dovecot-service #:config
11562 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
11563 (string "")))
11564 @end example
11565
11566 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
11567
11568 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
11569 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
11570 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
11571 as in this example:
11572
11573 @example
11574 (service opensmtpd-service-type
11575 (opensmtpd-configuration
11576 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
11577 @end example
11578 @end deffn
11579
11580 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
11581 Data type regresenting the configuration of opensmtpd.
11582
11583 @table @asis
11584 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
11585 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
11586
11587 @item @code{config-file} (default: @var{%default-opensmtpd-file})
11588 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
11589 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
11590 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
11591 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
11592
11593 @end table
11594 @end deftp
11595
11596 @node Kerberos Services
11597 @subsubsection Kerberos Services
11598 @cindex Kerberos
11599
11600 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
11601 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
11602
11603 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
11604
11605 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
11606 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
11607 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
11608 operating system declaration.
11609 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
11610
11611 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
11612 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
11613 Other implementations have not been tested.
11614
11615 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
11616 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
11617 @end defvr
11618
11619 @noindent
11620 Here is an example of its use:
11621 @lisp
11622 (service krb5-service-type
11623 (krb5-configuration
11624 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
11625 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
11626 (realms (list
11627 (krb5-realm
11628 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
11629 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
11630 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
11631 (krb5-realm
11632 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
11633 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
11634 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
11635 @end lisp
11636
11637 @noindent
11638 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
11639 @itemize
11640 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
11641 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
11642 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
11643 specified by clients;
11644 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
11645 @end itemize
11646
11647 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
11648 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
11649 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
11650 @uref{http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
11651 documentation.
11652
11653
11654 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
11655 @cindex realm, kerberos
11656 @table @asis
11657 @item @code{name}
11658 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
11659 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
11660 converted to upper case.
11661
11662 @item @code{admin-server}
11663 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
11664 running.
11665
11666 @item @code{kdc}
11667 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
11668 for the realm.
11669 @end table
11670 @end deftp
11671
11672 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
11673
11674 @table @asis
11675 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
11676 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
11677 known to be weak will be accepted.
11678
11679 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
11680 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
11681 realm for the client.
11682 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
11683 If this value is @code{#f}
11684 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
11685 such as @command{kinit}.
11686
11687 @item @code{realms}
11688 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
11689 access.
11690 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
11691 field.
11692 @end table
11693 @end deftp
11694
11695
11696 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
11697 @cindex pam-krb5
11698
11699 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
11700 management via Kerberos.
11701 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
11702 users using Kerberos.
11703
11704 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
11705 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
11706 @end defvr
11707
11708 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
11709 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module
11710 This type has the following parameters:
11711 @table @asis
11712 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
11713 The pam-krb5 package to use.
11714
11715 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
11716 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
11717 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
11718 @end table
11719 @end deftp
11720
11721
11722 @node Web Services
11723 @subsubsection Web Services
11724
11725 @cindex web
11726 @cindex www
11727 @cindex HTTP
11728 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
11729
11730 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
11731 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
11732 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
11733 [#:vhost-list (list (nginx-vhost-configuration))] @
11734 [#:config-file]
11735
11736 Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
11737
11738 The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
11739 Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
11740 files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
11741 arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
11742 directories are created when the service is activated.
11743
11744 As an alternative to using a @var{config-file}, @var{vhost-list} can be
11745 used to specify the list of @dfn{virtual hosts} required on the host. For
11746 this to work, use the default value for @var{config-file}.
11747
11748 @end deffn
11749
11750 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-vhost-configuration
11751 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx virtual host.
11752 This type has the following parameters:
11753
11754 @table @asis
11755 @item @code{http-port} (default: @code{80})
11756 Nginx will listen for HTTP connection on this port. Set it at @code{#f} if
11757 nginx should not listen for HTTP (non secure) connection for this
11758 @dfn{virtual host}.
11759
11760 @item @code{https-port} (default: @code{443})
11761 Nginx will listen for HTTPS connection on this port. Set it at @code{#f} if
11762 nginx should not listen for HTTPS (secure) connection for this @dfn{virtual host}.
11763
11764 Note that nginx can listen for HTTP and HTTPS connections in the same
11765 @dfn{virtual host}.
11766
11767 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
11768 A list of server names this vhost represents. @code{'default} represents the
11769 default vhost for connections matching no other vhost.
11770
11771 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
11772 Root of the website nginx will serve.
11773
11774 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
11775 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
11776 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
11777
11778 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{"/etc/nginx/cert.pem"})
11779 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
11780 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
11781
11782 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{"/etc/nginx/key.pem"})
11783 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
11784 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
11785
11786 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
11787 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
11788
11789 @end table
11790 @end deftp
11791
11792 @node Network File System
11793 @subsubsection Network File System
11794 @cindex NFS
11795
11796 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
11797 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
11798 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
11799
11800 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
11801 @cindex rpcbind
11802
11803 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
11804 universal addresses.
11805 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
11806 started when a dependent service starts.
11807
11808 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
11809 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
11810 @end defvr
11811
11812
11813 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
11814 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
11815 This type has the following parameters:
11816 @table @asis
11817 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
11818 The rpcbind package to use.
11819
11820 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
11821 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
11822 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
11823 instance.
11824 @end table
11825 @end deftp
11826
11827
11828 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
11829 @cindex pipefs
11830 @cindex rpc_pipefs
11831
11832 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
11833 between the kernel and user space programs.
11834
11835 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
11836 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
11837 @end defvr
11838
11839 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
11840 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
11841 This type has the following parameters:
11842 @table @asis
11843 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11844 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
11845 @end table
11846 @end deftp
11847
11848
11849 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
11850 @cindex GSSD
11851 @cindex GSS
11852 @cindex global security system
11853
11854 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
11855 based protocols.
11856 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
11857 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
11858 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
11859
11860 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
11861 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
11862 @end defvr
11863
11864 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
11865 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
11866 This type has the following parameters:
11867 @table @asis
11868 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
11869 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
11870
11871 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11872 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
11873
11874 @end table
11875 @end deftp
11876
11877
11878 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
11879 @cindex idmapd
11880 @cindex name mapper
11881
11882 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
11883 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
11884
11885 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
11886 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
11887 @end defvr
11888
11889 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
11890 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
11891 This type has the following parameters:
11892 @table @asis
11893 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
11894 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
11895
11896 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11897 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
11898
11899 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
11900 The local NFSv4 domain name.
11901 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
11902 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
11903
11904 @end table
11905 @end deftp
11906
11907 @node Continuous Integration
11908 @subsubsection Continuous Integration
11909
11910 @cindex continuous integration
11911 @uref{https://notabug.org/mthl/cuirass, Cuirass} is a continuous
11912 integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and for
11913 providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
11914
11915 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
11916
11917 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service @
11918 [#:config @code{(cuirass-configuration)}]
11919 Return a service that runs @command{cuirass}.
11920
11921 The @var{#:config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
11922 @command{cuirass}, which must be a @code{<cuirass-configuration>}
11923 object, by default it doesn't provide any build job. If you want to
11924 provide your own configuration you will most likely use the
11925 @code{cuirass-configuration} special form which returns such objects.
11926 @end deffn
11927
11928 In order to add build jobs you will have to set the
11929 @code{specifications} field. Here is an example of a cuirass service
11930 defining a build job based on a specification that can be found in
11931 Cuirass source tree.
11932
11933 @example
11934 (let ((spec `((#:name . "guix")
11935 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
11936 (#:load-path . ".")
11937 ;; Adapt to a valid absolute file name.
11938 (#:file . "/.../cuirass/tests/gnu-system.scm")
11939 (#:proc . hydra-jobs)
11940 (#:arguments (subset . "hello"))
11941 (#:branch . "master"))))
11942 (cuirass-service #:config (cuirass-configuration
11943 (specifications (list spec)))))
11944 @end example
11945
11946 While information related to build jobs are located directly in the
11947 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
11948 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
11949
11950 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
11951 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
11952
11953 @table @asis
11954 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{""})
11955 Location of the repository cache.
11956
11957 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
11958 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
11959
11960 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
11961 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
11962
11963 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
11964 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
11965 Cuirass jobs.
11966
11967 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/run/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
11968 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
11969 added specifications.
11970
11971 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{'()})
11972 A list of specifications, where a specification is an association list
11973 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
11974 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
11975 above.
11976
11977 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
11978 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
11979 from source.
11980
11981 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
11982 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
11983 @end table
11984 @end deftp
11985
11986 @node Miscellaneous Services
11987 @subsubsection Miscellaneous Services
11988
11989
11990 @cindex lirc
11991 @subsubheading Lirc Service
11992
11993 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
11994
11995 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
11996 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
11997 [#:extra-options '()]
11998 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
11999 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
12000
12001 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
12002 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
12003 for details.
12004
12005 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
12006 passed to @command{lircd}.
12007 @end deffn
12008
12009 @cindex spice
12010 @subsubheading Spice Service
12011
12012 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
12013
12014 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
12015 Returns a service that runs @url{http://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
12016 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
12017 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
12018 @end deffn
12019
12020 @subsubsection Dictionary Services
12021 @cindex dictionary
12022 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
12023
12024 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
12025 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
12026 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12027
12028 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
12029 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
12030 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
12031
12032 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
12033 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
12034 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12035 @end deffn
12036
12037 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
12038 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
12039
12040 @table @asis
12041 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
12042 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
12043
12044 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
12045 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
12046 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
12047 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12048
12049 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
12050 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
12051 @end table
12052 @end deftp
12053
12054 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
12055 Data type representing a dictionary database.
12056
12057 @table @asis
12058 @item @code{name}
12059 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
12060
12061 @item @code{module}
12062 Name of the dicod module used by this database
12063 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12064
12065 @item @code{options}
12066 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
12067 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12068 @end table
12069 @end deftp
12070
12071 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
12072 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
12073 Dictonary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
12074 @end defvr
12075
12076 @subsubsection Version Control
12077
12078 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides the following services:
12079
12080 @subsubheading Git daemon service
12081
12082 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
12083
12084 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
12085 expose repositiories over the Git protocol for annoymous access.
12086
12087 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
12088 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
12089 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
12090 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
12091 @file{/srv/git}.
12092
12093 @end deffn
12094
12095 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
12096 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
12097
12098 @table @asis
12099 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
12100 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
12101
12102 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
12103 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
12104 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
12105
12106 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
12107 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
12108 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
12109 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
12110 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
12111
12112 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
12113 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
12114 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
12115 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
12116 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
12117 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
12118 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
12119
12120 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
12121 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
12122 all.
12123
12124 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
12125 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
12126
12127 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
12128 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
12129
12130 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
12131 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
12132 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
12133
12134 @end table
12135 @end deftp
12136
12137 @node Setuid Programs
12138 @subsection Setuid Programs
12139
12140 @cindex setuid programs
12141 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
12142 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
12143 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
12144 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
12145 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
12146 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
12147 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
12148 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
12149 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
12150
12151 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
12152 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
12153 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
12154 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
12155 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
12156 should be setuid root.
12157
12158 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
12159 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
12160 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
12161 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
12162 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
12163
12164 @example
12165 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
12166 @end example
12167
12168 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
12169 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
12170
12171 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
12172 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
12173
12174 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
12175 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
12176 @end defvr
12177
12178 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
12179 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
12180 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
12181 store.
12182
12183 @node X.509 Certificates
12184 @subsection X.509 Certificates
12185
12186 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
12187 @cindex X.509 certificates
12188 @cindex TLS
12189 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
12190 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
12191 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
12192 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
12193 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
12194 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
12195
12196 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
12197 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
12198 out-of-the-box.
12199
12200 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
12201 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
12202 certificates can be found.
12203
12204 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
12205 In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
12206 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
12207 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
12208 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
12209 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
12210
12211 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
12212 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
12213 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
12214 to the certificates installed globally.
12215
12216 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
12217 can also install their own certificate package in
12218 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
12219 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
12220 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
12221 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
12222 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
12223 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
12224 would typically run something like:
12225
12226 @example
12227 $ guix package -i nss-certs
12228 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
12229 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
12230 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
12231 @end example
12232
12233 @node Name Service Switch
12234 @subsection Name Service Switch
12235
12236 @cindex name service switch
12237 @cindex NSS
12238 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
12239 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
12240 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
12241 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
12242 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
12243 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
12244 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
12245 C Library Reference Manual}).
12246
12247 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
12248 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
12249 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
12250 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
12251 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
12252 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
12253
12254 @cindex nss-mdns
12255 @cindex .local, host name lookup
12256 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
12257 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
12258 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
12259 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
12260
12261 @example
12262 (name-service-switch
12263 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
12264
12265 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
12266 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
12267 (name-service
12268 (name "mdns_minimal")
12269
12270 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
12271 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
12272 ;; no need to try the next methods.
12273 (reaction (lookup-specification
12274 (not-found => return))))
12275
12276 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
12277 (name-service
12278 (name "dns"))
12279
12280 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
12281 (name-service
12282 (name "mdns")))))
12283 @end example
12284
12285 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
12286 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
12287 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
12288
12289 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
12290 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
12291 you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
12292 @code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
12293 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
12294 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
12295 @code{nscd-service}}).
12296
12297 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
12298 configurations.
12299
12300 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
12301 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
12302 @code{name-service-switch} object.
12303 @end defvr
12304
12305 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
12306 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
12307 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
12308 @end defvr
12309
12310 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
12311 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
12312 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
12313 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12314 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
12315 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
12316 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
12317 run @command{guix system}.
12318
12319 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
12320
12321 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
12322 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
12323 system databases.
12324
12325 @table @code
12326 @item aliases
12327 @itemx ethers
12328 @itemx group
12329 @itemx gshadow
12330 @itemx hosts
12331 @itemx initgroups
12332 @itemx netgroup
12333 @itemx networks
12334 @itemx password
12335 @itemx public-key
12336 @itemx rpc
12337 @itemx services
12338 @itemx shadow
12339 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
12340 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
12341 @end table
12342 @end deftp
12343
12344 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
12345
12346 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
12347 associated lookup action.
12348
12349 @table @code
12350 @item name
12351 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
12352 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12353
12354 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
12355 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
12356 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
12357 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
12358
12359 @item reaction
12360 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
12361 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12362 Reference Manual}). For example:
12363
12364 @example
12365 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
12366 (success => return))
12367 @end example
12368 @end table
12369 @end deftp
12370
12371 @node Initial RAM Disk
12372 @subsection Initial RAM Disk
12373
12374 @cindex initrd
12375 @cindex initial RAM disk
12376 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
12377 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
12378 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
12379 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
12380 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
12381
12382 The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
12383 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
12384 system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
12385 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
12386 @code{expression->initrd} procedure.
12387
12388 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
12389 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
12390 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
12391 system declaration like this:
12392
12393 @example
12394 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
12395 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
12396 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
12397 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
12398 (apply base-initrd file-systems
12399 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
12400 rest)))
12401 @end example
12402
12403 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
12404 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
12405 volatile root file system.
12406
12407 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
12408 options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
12409 passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
12410 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
12411
12412 @table @code
12413 @item --load=@var{boot}
12414 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
12415 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
12416
12417 GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
12418 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
12419 initialization system.
12420
12421 @item --root=@var{root}
12422 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
12423 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
12424 UUID.
12425
12426 @item --system=@var{system}
12427 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
12428 @var{system}.
12429
12430 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
12431 @cindex module, black-listing
12432 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
12433 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
12434 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
12435 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
12436 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
12437
12438 @item --repl
12439 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
12440 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
12441 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
12442 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
12443 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
12444
12445 @end table
12446
12447 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
12448 @code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
12449 further.
12450
12451 @cindex initrd
12452 @cindex initial RAM disk
12453 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
12454 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
12455 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
12456 Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
12457 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
12458 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
12459 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
12460 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
12461
12462 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
12463 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
12464 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
12465
12466 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
12467 to it are lost.
12468
12469 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
12470 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
12471 modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
12472 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
12473 @end deffn
12474
12475 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
12476 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
12477 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
12478 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
12479 program to run in that initrd.
12480
12481 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
12482 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
12483 Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
12484 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
12485 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
12486 automatically copied to the initrd.
12487 @end deffn
12488
12489 @node GRUB Configuration
12490 @subsection GRUB Configuration
12491
12492 @cindex GRUB
12493 @cindex boot loader
12494
12495 The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
12496 (@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
12497 configured using a @code{grub-configuration} declaration. This data type
12498 is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module and described below.
12499
12500 @deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
12501 The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
12502
12503 @table @asis
12504
12505 @item @code{device}
12506 This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
12507 understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
12508 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
12509 GNU GRUB Manual}).
12510
12511 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
12512 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
12513 entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
12514 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
12515
12516 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
12517 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
12518 current system.
12519
12520 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
12521 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
12522 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
12523
12524 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
12525 The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
12526 @end table
12527
12528 @end deftp
12529
12530 @cindex dual boot
12531 @cindex boot menu
12532 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
12533 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
12534 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
12535 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
12536 along these lines:
12537
12538 @example
12539 (menu-entry
12540 (label "The Other Distro")
12541 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
12542 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
12543 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
12544 @end example
12545
12546 Details below.
12547
12548 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
12549 The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
12550
12551 @table @asis
12552
12553 @item @code{label}
12554 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
12555
12556 @item @code{linux}
12557 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
12558
12559 @example
12560 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
12561 @end example
12562
12563 It is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the file path
12564 using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming convention,,, grub,
12565 GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
12566
12567 @example
12568 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
12569 @end example
12570
12571 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
12572 field is ignored entirely.
12573
12574 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
12575 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
12576 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
12577
12578 @item @code{initrd}
12579 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
12580 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12581
12582 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
12583 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., the GRUB
12584 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
12585
12586 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
12587 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case GRUB will
12588 search the device containing the file specified by the @code{linux}
12589 field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It must @emph{not} be
12590 an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
12591
12592 @item @code{device-mount-point} (default: @code{"/"})
12593 The mount point of the above device on the system. You probably do not
12594 need to change the default value. GuixSD uses it to strip the prefix of
12595 store file names for systems where @file{/gnu} or @file{/gnu/store} is
12596 on a separate partition.
12597
12598 @end table
12599 @end deftp
12600
12601 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
12602 Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
12603 documented yet.
12604
12605 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
12606 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
12607 fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
12608 @end defvr
12609
12610
12611 @node Invoking guix system
12612 @subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
12613
12614 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
12615 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
12616 system} command. The synopsis is:
12617
12618 @example
12619 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
12620 @end example
12621
12622 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
12623 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
12624 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
12625 supported:
12626
12627 @table @code
12628 @item reconfigure
12629 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
12630 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
12631 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
12632 systems already running GuixSD.}.
12633
12634 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
12635 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
12636 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
12637 currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
12638 attempt to upgrade it since this would not be possible without stopping it
12639 first.
12640
12641 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
12642 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
12643 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
12644 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
12645 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
12646
12647 It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
12648 entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
12649 @option{--no-grub} is passed.
12650
12651 @quotation Note
12652 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
12653 @c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
12654 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
12655 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
12656 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
12657 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
12658 @end quotation
12659
12660 @item switch-generation
12661 @cindex generations
12662 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
12663 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It also
12664 rearranges the system's existing GRUB menu entries. It makes the menu
12665 entry for the specified system generation the default, and it moves the
12666 entries for the other generations to a submenu. The next time the
12667 system boots, it will use the specified system generation.
12668
12669 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
12670 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
12671 generation 7:
12672
12673 @example
12674 guix system switch-generation 7
12675 @end example
12676
12677 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
12678 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
12679 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
12680 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
12681 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
12682 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
12683
12684 @example
12685 guix system switch-generation -- -1
12686 @end example
12687
12688 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
12689 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the GRUB menu
12690 entries. To actually start using the target system generation, you must
12691 reboot after running this action. In the future, it will be updated to
12692 do the same things as @command{reconfigure}, like activating and
12693 deactivating services.
12694
12695 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
12696
12697 @item roll-back
12698 @cindex rolling back
12699 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
12700 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
12701 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
12702 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
12703
12704 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
12705 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
12706 generation.
12707
12708 @item build
12709 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
12710 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
12711 This action does not actually install anything.
12712
12713 @item init
12714 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
12715 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
12716 installations of GuixSD. For instance:
12717
12718 @example
12719 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
12720 @end example
12721
12722 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
12723 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
12724 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
12725 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
12726 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
12727
12728 This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
12729 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
12730
12731 @item vm
12732 @cindex virtual machine
12733 @cindex VM
12734 @anchor{guix system vm}
12735 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
12736 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
12737 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU.
12738
12739 The VM shares its store with the host system.
12740
12741 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
12742 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
12743 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
12744 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
12745
12746 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
12747 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
12748 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
12749
12750 @example
12751 guix system vm my-config.scm \
12752 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
12753 @end example
12754
12755 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
12756 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
12757 store of the host can then be mounted.
12758
12759 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
12760 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
12761 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
12762 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
12763 size of the image.
12764
12765 @item vm-image
12766 @itemx disk-image
12767 Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
12768 in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
12769 to specify the size of the image.
12770
12771 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
12772 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
12773 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
12774
12775 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
12776 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
12777 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
12778 using the following command:
12779
12780 @example
12781 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
12782 @end example
12783
12784 @item container
12785 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
12786 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
12787 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
12788 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
12789 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
12790 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
12791
12792 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
12793 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
12794 system.
12795
12796 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
12797 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
12798 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
12799
12800 @example
12801 guix system container my-config.scm \
12802 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
12803 @end example
12804
12805 @quotation Note
12806 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
12807 @end quotation
12808
12809 @end table
12810
12811 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
12812 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
12813 following:
12814
12815 @table @option
12816 @item --system=@var{system}
12817 @itemx -s @var{system}
12818 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
12819 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
12820
12821 @item --derivation
12822 @itemx -d
12823 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
12824 building anything.
12825
12826 @item --image-size=@var{size}
12827 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
12828 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
12829 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
12830 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
12831
12832 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
12833 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
12834 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
12835
12836 @table @code
12837 @item nothing-special
12838 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
12839
12840 @item backtrace
12841 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
12842
12843 @item debug
12844 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
12845 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
12846 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
12847 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
12848 a list of available debugging commands.
12849 @end table
12850 @end table
12851
12852 @quotation Note
12853 All the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
12854 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
12855 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
12856 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
12857 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
12858 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
12859 @end quotation
12860
12861 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
12862 your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
12863 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
12864 GRUB boot menu:
12865
12866 @table @code
12867
12868 @item list-generations
12869 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
12870 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
12871 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
12872 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
12873
12874 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
12875 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
12876 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
12877 generations that are up to 10 days old:
12878
12879 @example
12880 $ guix system list-generations 10d
12881 @end example
12882
12883 @end table
12884
12885 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
12886 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
12887 each other:
12888
12889 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
12890 @table @code
12891
12892 @item extension-graph
12893 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
12894 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
12895 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
12896 extensions.)
12897
12898 The command:
12899
12900 @example
12901 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
12902 @end example
12903
12904 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
12905
12906 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
12907 @item shepherd-graph
12908 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
12909 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
12910 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
12911 example graph.
12912
12913 @end table
12914
12915 @node Running GuixSD in a VM
12916 @subsection Running GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
12917
12918 @cindex virtual machine
12919 One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
12920 virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
12921 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
12922 which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
12923
12924 @cindex QEMU
12925 To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
12926 and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
12927 you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
12928 platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
12929 of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
12930
12931 @example
12932 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
12933 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
12934 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
12935 @end example
12936
12937 Here is what each of these options means:
12938
12939 @table @code
12940 @item qemu-system-x86_64
12941 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
12942 host.
12943
12944 @item -net user
12945 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
12946 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
12947 guest OS online.
12948
12949 @item -net nic,model=virtio
12950 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
12951 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
12952 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
12953 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
12954
12955 @item -enable-kvm
12956 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
12957 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
12958 faster.
12959
12960 @item -m 256
12961 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
12962 which may be insufficient for some operations.
12963
12964 @item /tmp/qemu-image
12965 The file name of the qcow2 image.
12966 @end table
12967
12968 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invokation of
12969 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
12970 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
12971 to your system definition and start the VM using
12972 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
12973 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
12974 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
12975 network connectivity, like for example @command{curl}.
12976
12977 @subsubsection Connecting Through SSH
12978
12979 @cindex SSH
12980 @cindex SSH server
12981 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add a SSH server like @code{(dropbear-service)}
12982 or @code{(lsh-service)} to your VM. The @code{(lsh-service}) doesn't currently
12983 boot unsupervised. It requires you to type some characters to initialize the
12984 randomness generator. In addition you need to forward the SSH port, 22 by
12985 default, to the host. You can do this with
12986
12987 @example
12988 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
12989 @end example
12990
12991 To connect to the VM you can run
12992
12993 @example
12994 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
12995 @end example
12996
12997 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
12998 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
12999 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
13000 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
13001 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
13002
13003 @subsubsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
13004
13005 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
13006 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
13007 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
13008 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
13009
13010 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
13011 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
13012
13013 @example
13014 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
13015 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
13016 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
13017 name=com.redhat.spice.0
13018 @end example
13019
13020 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
13021
13022 @node Defining Services
13023 @subsection Defining Services
13024
13025 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
13026 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
13027 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
13028
13029 @menu
13030 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
13031 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
13032 * Service Reference:: API reference.
13033 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
13034 @end menu
13035
13036 @node Service Composition
13037 @subsubsection Service Composition
13038
13039 @cindex services
13040 @cindex daemons
13041 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
13042 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
13043 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
13044 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
13045 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
13046 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
13047 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
13048 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
13049 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
13050 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
13051 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
13052 of the system.
13053
13054 @cindex service extensions
13055 GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
13056 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the GuixSD
13057 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
13058 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
13059 Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
13060 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
13061 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
13062 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
13063 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
13064 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
13065 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
13066
13067 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
13068 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
13069 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
13070
13071 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
13072
13073 @cindex system service
13074 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
13075 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
13076 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
13077 to learn about the other service types shown here.
13078 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
13079 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
13080 particular operating system definition.
13081
13082 @cindex service types
13083 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
13084 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
13085 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
13086 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
13087 different parameters.
13088
13089 The following section describes the programming interface for service
13090 types and services.
13091
13092 @node Service Types and Services
13093 @subsubsection Service Types and Services
13094
13095 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
13096 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
13097 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
13098
13099 @example
13100 (define guix-service-type
13101 (service-type
13102 (name 'guix)
13103 (extensions
13104 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
13105 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
13106 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
13107 @end example
13108
13109 @noindent
13110 It defines two things:
13111
13112 @enumerate
13113 @item
13114 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
13115
13116 @item
13117 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
13118 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
13119 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
13120
13121 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
13122 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
13123 @end enumerate
13124
13125 In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
13126
13127 @table @var
13128 @item shepherd-root-service-type
13129 The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
13130 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
13131 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
13132 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
13133
13134 @item account-service-type
13135 This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
13136 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
13137 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
13138 guix-daemon}).
13139
13140 @item activation-service-type
13141 Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
13142 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
13143 booted.
13144 @end table
13145
13146 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
13147
13148 @example
13149 (service guix-service-type
13150 (guix-configuration
13151 (build-accounts 5)
13152 (use-substitutes? #f)))
13153 @end example
13154
13155 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
13156 the parameters of this specific service instance.
13157 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
13158 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
13159
13160 @var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
13161 services but is not extensible itself.
13162
13163 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
13164
13165 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
13166
13167 @example
13168 (define udev-service-type
13169 (service-type (name 'udev)
13170 (extensions
13171 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
13172 udev-shepherd-service)))
13173
13174 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
13175 (extend (lambda (config rules)
13176 (match config
13177 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
13178 (udev-configuration
13179 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
13180 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
13181 @end example
13182
13183 This is the service type for the
13184 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
13185 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
13186 extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
13187
13188 @table @code
13189 @item compose
13190 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
13191 services of this type.
13192
13193 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
13194 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
13195
13196 @item extend
13197 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
13198 the composition of the extensions.
13199
13200 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
13201 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
13202 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
13203 list of contributed rules.
13204 @end table
13205
13206 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
13207 @var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
13208 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
13209
13210 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
13211 interface for services.
13212
13213 @node Service Reference
13214 @subsubsection Service Reference
13215
13216 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
13217 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
13218 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
13219 @code{(gnu services)} module.
13220
13221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
13222 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
13223 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
13224 this particular service instance.
13225 @end deffn
13226
13227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
13228 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
13229 @end deffn
13230
13231 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
13232 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
13233 @end deffn
13234
13235 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
13236 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
13237 parameters.
13238 @end deffn
13239
13240 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
13241
13242 @example
13243 (define s
13244 (service nginx-service-type
13245 (nginx-configuration
13246 (nginx nginx)
13247 (log-directory log-directory)
13248 (run-directory run-directory)
13249 (file config-file))))
13250
13251 (service? s)
13252 @result{} #t
13253
13254 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
13255 @result{} #t
13256 @end example
13257
13258 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
13259 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
13260 @var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
13261 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
13262 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
13263 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
13264 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
13265 common pattern.
13266
13267 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
13268 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
13269
13270 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
13271 clauses. Each clause has the form:
13272
13273 @example
13274 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
13275 @end example
13276
13277 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
13278 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
13279 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
13280 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
13281 @var{type}.
13282
13283 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
13284 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
13285 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
13286 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
13287 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
13288 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
13289
13290 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
13291
13292 @end deffn
13293
13294 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
13295 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
13296 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
13297 @code{operating-system} declaration.
13298
13299 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
13300 @cindex service type
13301 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
13302 and Services}).
13303
13304 @table @asis
13305 @item @code{name}
13306 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
13307
13308 @item @code{extensions}
13309 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
13310
13311 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
13312 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
13313 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
13314 services.
13315
13316 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
13317 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
13318 extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
13319 the service instance.
13320
13321 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
13322 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
13323
13324 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
13325 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first argument
13326 and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
13327 second argument.
13328 @end table
13329
13330 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
13331 @end deftp
13332
13333 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
13334 @var{compute}
13335 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
13336 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
13337 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
13338 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
13339 @end deffn
13340
13341 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
13342 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
13343 @end deffn
13344
13345 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
13346 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
13347 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
13348 provides a shorthand for this.
13349
13350 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
13351 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
13352 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
13353 service is an instance.
13354
13355 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
13356 an additional job:
13357
13358 @example
13359 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
13360 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
13361 @end example
13362 @end deffn
13363
13364 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
13365 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
13366 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
13367 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
13368 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
13369 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
13370 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
13371
13372 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
13373 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
13374 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
13375 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
13376 @end deffn
13377
13378 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
13379 service types, some of which are listed below.
13380
13381 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
13382 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
13383 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
13384 @end defvr
13385
13386 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
13387 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
13388 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
13389 @end defvr
13390
13391 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
13392 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
13393 passing it name/file tuples such as:
13394
13395 @example
13396 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
13397 @end example
13398
13399 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
13400 pointing to the given file.
13401 @end defvr
13402
13403 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
13404 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
13405 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
13406 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
13407 @end defvr
13408
13409 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
13410 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
13411 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
13412 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
13413 @end defvr
13414
13415
13416 @node Shepherd Services
13417 @subsubsection Shepherd Services
13418
13419 @cindex shepherd services
13420 @cindex PID 1
13421 @cindex init system
13422 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
13423 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the GuixSD
13424 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
13425 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
13426 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
13427
13428 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
13429 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
13430 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
13431 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
13432 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
13433
13434 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
13435
13436 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
13437 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
13438 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
13439
13440 The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
13441 PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
13442 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
13443
13444 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
13445 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
13446
13447 @table @asis
13448 @item @code{provision}
13449 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
13450
13451 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
13452 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
13453 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
13454 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
13455
13456 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
13457 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
13458
13459 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
13460 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
13461 underlying process dies.
13462
13463 @item @code{start}
13464 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
13465 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
13466 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
13467 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
13468 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
13469 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
13470
13471 @item @code{documentation}
13472 A documentation string, as shown when running:
13473
13474 @example
13475 herd doc @var{service-name}
13476 @end example
13477
13478 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
13479 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
13480
13481 @item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
13482 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
13483 @code{stop} are evaluated.
13484
13485 @end table
13486 @end deftp
13487
13488 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
13489 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
13490
13491 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
13492 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
13493 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
13494 @end defvr
13495
13496 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
13497 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
13498 @end defvr
13499
13500
13501 @node Installing Debugging Files
13502 @section Installing Debugging Files
13503
13504 @cindex debugging files
13505 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
13506 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
13507 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
13508 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
13509 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
13510
13511 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
13512 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
13513 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
13514 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
13515 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
13516 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
13517 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
13518
13519 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
13520 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
13521 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
13522 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
13523 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
13524 with GDB}).
13525
13526 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
13527 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
13528 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
13529 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
13530 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
13531 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
13532 Guile:
13533
13534 @example
13535 guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
13536 @end example
13537
13538 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
13539 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
13540 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
13541 GDB}):
13542
13543 @example
13544 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
13545 @end example
13546
13547 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
13548 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
13549
13550 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
13551 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
13552 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
13553 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
13554 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
13555 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
13556
13557 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
13558 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
13559 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
13560 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
13561 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
13562 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
13563 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
13564 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
13565
13566
13567 @node Security Updates
13568 @section Security Updates
13569
13570 @cindex security updates
13571 @cindex security vulnerabilities
13572 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
13573 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
13574 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
13575 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
13576 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
13577 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
13578 distribution:
13579
13580 @smallexample
13581 $ guix lint -c cve
13582 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc-2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
13583 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc-4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
13584 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg-2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
13585 @dots{}
13586 @end smallexample
13587
13588 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
13589
13590 @quotation Note
13591 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
13592 ``beta''.
13593 @end quotation
13594
13595 Guix follows a functional
13596 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
13597 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
13598 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
13599 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
13600 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
13601 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
13602 desired.
13603
13604 @cindex grafts
13605 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
13606 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
13607 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
13608 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
13609 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
13610 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
13611 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
13612
13613 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
13614 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
13615 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
13616 Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
13617 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
13618 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
13619
13620 @example
13621 (define bash
13622 (package
13623 (name "bash")
13624 ;; @dots{}
13625 (replacement bash-fixed)))
13626 @end example
13627
13628 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
13629 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13630 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
13631 @var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
13632 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
13633 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
13634 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
13635 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
13636
13637 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
13638 the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and @var{bash} in the example
13639 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
13640 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
13641 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
13642 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
13643 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
13644
13645 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
13646 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
13647 Thus, the command:
13648
13649 @example
13650 guix build bash --no-grafts
13651 @end example
13652
13653 @noindent
13654 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
13655
13656 @example
13657 guix build bash
13658 @end example
13659
13660 @noindent
13661 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
13662 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
13663
13664 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
13665 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
13666
13667 @example
13668 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
13669 @end example
13670
13671 @noindent
13672 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
13673 Likewise for a complete GuixSD system generation:
13674
13675 @example
13676 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
13677 @end example
13678
13679 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
13680 @command{lsof} command:
13681
13682 @example
13683 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
13684 @end example
13685
13686
13687 @node Package Modules
13688 @section Package Modules
13689
13690 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
13691 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
13692 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
13693 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
13694 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
13695 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
13696 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
13697 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
13698 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
13699 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
13700 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
13701
13702 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
13703 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
13704 instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
13705 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
13706 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
13707 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
13708
13709 @cindex customization, of packages
13710 @cindex package module search path
13711 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
13712 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
13713 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
13714 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
13715 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
13716 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
13717 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
13718 will not be visible by default. Users can invoke commands such as
13719 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} with the
13720 @code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
13721 yet, they can use the
13722 @code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
13723 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
13724 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
13725 variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
13726 honored by all the user interfaces.
13727
13728 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
13729 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
13730 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
13731 over the own modules of the distribution.
13732 @end defvr
13733
13734 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
13735 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
13736 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
13737 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
13738 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
13739 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
13740
13741 @node Packaging Guidelines
13742 @section Packaging Guidelines
13743
13744 @cindex packages, creating
13745 The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
13746 packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
13747 grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
13748 help.
13749
13750 Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
13751 @dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
13752 all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
13753 essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
13754 build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
13755 it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
13756 description and licensing information.
13757
13758 In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
13759 Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
13760 written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
13761 for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
13762 and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
13763 However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
13764 creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
13765 @pxref{Defining Packages}.
13766
13767 Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
13768 source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
13769 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
13770 called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
13771 (@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
13772
13773 @example
13774 ./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
13775 @end example
13776
13777 Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
13778 it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
13779 command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
13780 build log.
13781
13782 If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
13783 the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
13784 clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
13785 the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
13786
13787 @example
13788 ./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
13789 @end example
13790
13791 Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
13792 (@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
13793 help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
13794 new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
13795 @url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
13796 system}.
13797
13798 @cindex substituter
13799 Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
13800 @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
13801 @code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
13802 package automatically downloads binaries from there
13803 (@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
13804 needed is to review and apply the patch.
13805
13806
13807 @menu
13808 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
13809 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
13810 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
13811 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
13812 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
13813 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
13814 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
13815 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
13816 @end menu
13817
13818 @node Software Freedom
13819 @subsection Software Freedom
13820
13821 @c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
13822 @cindex free software
13823 The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
13824 freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
13825 users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
13826 essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
13827 in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
13828 modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
13829 software that conveys these four freedoms.
13830
13831 In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
13832 @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
13833 software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
13834 reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
13835 discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
13836
13837 Some otherwise free upstream package sources contain a small and optional
13838 subset that violates the above guidelines, for instance because this subset
13839 is itself non-free code. When that happens, the offending items are removed
13840 with appropriate patches or code snippets in the @code{origin} form of the
13841 package (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This way, @code{guix
13842 build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
13843 upstream source.
13844
13845
13846 @node Package Naming
13847 @subsection Package Naming
13848
13849 @cindex package name
13850 A package has actually two names associated with it:
13851 First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
13852 @code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
13853 Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
13854 the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
13855 is used by package management commands such as
13856 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
13857
13858 Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
13859 the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
13860 hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
13861 SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
13862
13863 We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
13864 already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
13865 Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
13866 the Python and Perl languages.
13867
13868 Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
13869
13870
13871 @node Version Numbers
13872 @subsection Version Numbers
13873
13874 @cindex package version
13875 We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
13876 project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
13877 two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
13878 different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
13879 in @ref{Package Naming}
13880 for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
13881 by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
13882 distinguish the two versions.
13883
13884 The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
13885 package and does not contain any version number.
13886
13887 For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
13888
13889 @example
13890 (define-public gtk+
13891 (package
13892 (name "gtk+")
13893 (version "3.9.12")
13894 ...))
13895 (define-public gtk+-2
13896 (package
13897 (name "gtk+")
13898 (version "2.24.20")
13899 ...))
13900 @end example
13901 If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
13902 @example
13903 (define-public gtk+-3.8
13904 (package
13905 (name "gtk+")
13906 (version "3.8.2")
13907 ...))
13908 @end example
13909
13910 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
13911 @c for a discussion of what follows.
13912 @cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
13913 Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
13914 (VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
13915 because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
13916 release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
13917 the @code{version} field?
13918
13919 Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
13920 visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
13921 version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
13922 --upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
13923 identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
13924 a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
13925 snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
13926
13927 @example
13928 2.0.11-3.cabba9e
13929 ^ ^ ^
13930 | | `-- upstream commit ID
13931 | |
13932 | `--- Guix package revision
13933 |
13934 latest upstream version
13935 @end example
13936
13937 It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
13938 field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
13939 aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
13940 limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
13941 kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
13942 @code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities. A typical package
13943 definition may look like this:
13944
13945 @example
13946 (define my-package
13947 (let ((commit "c3f29bc928d5900971f65965feaae59e1272a3f7")
13948 (revision "1")) ;Guix package revision
13949 (package
13950 (version (string-append "0.9-" revision "."
13951 (string-take commit 7)))
13952 (source (origin
13953 (method git-fetch)
13954 (uri (git-reference
13955 (url "git://example.org/my-package.git")
13956 (commit commit)))
13957 (sha256 (base32 "1mbikn@dots{}"))
13958 (file-name (string-append "my-package-" version
13959 "-checkout"))))
13960 ;; @dots{}
13961 )))
13962 @end example
13963
13964 @node Synopses and Descriptions
13965 @subsection Synopses and Descriptions
13966
13967 @cindex package description
13968 @cindex package synopsis
13969 As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
13970 synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
13971 descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
13972 --search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
13973 determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
13974 packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
13975
13976 Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
13977 period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
13978 not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
13979 tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
13980 is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
13981 used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
13982 matching a pattern''.
13983
13984 Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
13985 audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
13986 might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
13987 fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
13988 is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
13989 application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
13990 something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
13991 hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
13992 looking for.
13993
13994 Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
13995 sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
13996 Please avoid marketing phrases such as ``world-leading'',
13997 ``industrial-strength'', and ``next-generation'', and avoid superlatives
13998 like ``the most advanced''---they are not helpful to users looking for a
13999 package and may even sound suspicious. Instead, try to be factual,
14000 mentioning use cases and features.
14001
14002 @cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
14003 Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
14004 ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
14005 hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
14006 should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
14007 curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
14008 (@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
14009 such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
14010 appropriately.
14011
14012 Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
14013 @uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
14014 Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
14015 their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
14016 the language specified by the current locale.
14017
14018 Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
14019 attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
14020 additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
14021 to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
14022 special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
14023 Gettext}):
14024
14025 @example
14026 ;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
14027 (description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
14028 for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
14029 @end example
14030
14031
14032 @node Python Modules
14033 @subsection Python Modules
14034
14035 @cindex python
14036 We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
14037 @code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
14038 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
14039 seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
14040 the word @code{python}.
14041
14042 Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
14043 If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
14044 @code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
14045 @code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
14046 packages with the corresponding names.
14047
14048 If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
14049 for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
14050 @code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}. If the project name
14051 starts with @code{py} (e.g. @code{pytz}), we keep it and prefix it as
14052 described above.
14053
14054 @subsubsection Specifying Dependencies
14055 @cindex inputs, for Python packages
14056
14057 Dependency information for Python packages is usually available in the
14058 package source tree, with varying degrees of accuracy: in the
14059 @file{setup.py} file, in @file{requirements.txt}, or in @file{tox.ini}.
14060
14061 Your mission, when writing a recipe for a Python package, is to map
14062 these dependencies to the appropriate type of ``input'' (@pxref{package
14063 Reference, inputs}). Although the @code{pypi} importer normally does a
14064 good job (@pxref{Invoking guix import}), you may want to check the
14065 following check list to determine which dependency goes where.
14066
14067 @itemize
14068
14069 @item
14070 We currently package Python 2 with @code{setuptools} and @code{pip}
14071 installed like Python 3.4 has per default. Thus you don't need to
14072 specify either of these as an input. @command{guix lint} will warn you
14073 if you do.
14074
14075 @item
14076 Python dependencies required at run time go into
14077 @code{propagated-inputs}. They are typically defined with the
14078 @code{install_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}, or in the
14079 @file{requirements.txt} file.
14080
14081 @item
14082 Python packages required only at build time---e.g., those listed with
14083 the @code{setup_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}---or only for
14084 testing---e.g., those in @code{tests_require}---go into
14085 @code{native-inputs}. The rationale is that (1) they do not need to be
14086 propagated because they are not needed at run time, and (2) in a
14087 cross-compilation context, it's the ``native'' input that we'd want.
14088
14089 Examples are the @code{pytest}, @code{mock}, and @code{nose} test
14090 frameworks. Of course if any of these packages is also required at
14091 run-time, it needs to go to @code{propagated-inputs}.
14092
14093 @item
14094 Anything that does not fall in the previous categories goes to
14095 @code{inputs}, for example programs or C libraries required for building
14096 Python packages containing C extensions.
14097
14098 @item
14099 If a Python package has optional dependencies (@code{extras_require}),
14100 it is up to you to decide whether to add them or not, based on their
14101 usefulness/overhead ratio (@pxref{Submitting Patches, @command{guix
14102 size}}).
14103
14104 @end itemize
14105
14106
14107 @node Perl Modules
14108 @subsection Perl Modules
14109
14110 @cindex perl
14111 Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
14112 using the lowercase upstream name.
14113 For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
14114 replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
14115 @code{perl-}.
14116 So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
14117 Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
14118 are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
14119 @code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
14120 prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
14121
14122
14123 @node Java Packages
14124 @subsection Java Packages
14125
14126 @cindex java
14127 Java programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
14128 using the lowercase upstream name.
14129
14130 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages,
14131 it is desirable that the name of a package for a Java package is
14132 prefixed with @code{java-}. If a project already contains the word
14133 @code{java}, we drop this; for instance, the package @code{ngsjava} is
14134 packaged under the name @code{java-ngs}.
14135
14136 For Java packages containing a single class or a small class hierarchy,
14137 we use the lowercase class name, replace all occurrences of @code{.} by
14138 dashes and prepend the prefix @code{java-}. So the class
14139 @code{apache.commons.cli} becomes package
14140 @code{java-apache-commons-cli}.
14141
14142
14143 @node Fonts
14144 @subsection Fonts
14145
14146 @cindex fonts
14147 For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
14148 purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
14149 we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
14150 applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
14151 are part of TeX Live.
14152
14153 To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
14154 containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
14155 upstream package name.
14156
14157 The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
14158 @code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
14159 if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
14160 replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
14161 to lower case).
14162 For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
14163 @code{font-sil-gentium}.
14164
14165 For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
14166 is used in the place of the font family name.
14167 For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
14168 Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
14169 These could be packaged separately under the names
14170 @code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
14171 under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
14172 @code{font-liberation}.
14173
14174 In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
14175 are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
14176 is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
14177 @code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
14178 fonts.
14179
14180
14181
14182 @node Bootstrapping
14183 @section Bootstrapping
14184
14185 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
14186
14187 @cindex bootstrapping
14188
14189 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
14190 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
14191 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
14192 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
14193 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
14194 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
14195 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
14196 a ``regular user''.
14197
14198 @cindex bootstrap binaries
14199 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
14200 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
14201 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
14202 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
14203 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
14204 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
14205 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
14206 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
14207 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
14208
14209 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
14210 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
14211
14212 @unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
14213
14214 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
14215 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
14216 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
14217
14218 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
14219 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
14220 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
14221 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
14222
14223 @example
14224 guix graph -t derivation \
14225 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
14226 | dot -Tps > t.ps
14227 @end example
14228
14229 At this level of detail, things are
14230 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
14231 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
14232 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
14233 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
14234 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
14235 (@pxref{The Store}).
14236
14237 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
14238 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
14239 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
14240 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
14241 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
14242 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
14243 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
14244 tarball to be unpacked.
14245
14246 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
14247 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
14248 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
14249 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
14250 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
14251 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
14252 in the store, using the original layout. The
14253 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
14254 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
14255 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
14256 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
14257
14258 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
14259 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
14260 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
14261
14262
14263 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
14264
14265 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
14266 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
14267 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
14268 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
14269 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
14270 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
14271 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
14272
14273 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
14274 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
14275 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
14276 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
14277 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
14278 package from source. The command:
14279
14280 @example
14281 guix graph -t bag \
14282 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
14283 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
14284 @end example
14285
14286 @noindent
14287 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
14288 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
14289 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
14290 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
14291
14292 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
14293
14294 @c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
14295 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
14296 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
14297 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
14298 built.
14299
14300 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
14301 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
14302 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
14303 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
14304
14305 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
14306 GCC uses @code{ld}
14307 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
14308 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
14309 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
14310
14311 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
14312 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
14313 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
14314 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
14315 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
14316
14317
14318 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
14319
14320 @cindex bootstrap binaries
14321 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
14322 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
14323 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
14324 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
14325
14326 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
14327 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
14328 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
14329
14330 @example
14331 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
14332 @end example
14333
14334 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
14335 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
14336 this section.
14337
14338 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
14339 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
14340 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
14341 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
14342 know.
14343
14344 @node Porting
14345 @section Porting to a New Platform
14346
14347 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
14348 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
14349 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
14350 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
14351 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
14352 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
14353 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
14354
14355 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
14356 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
14357 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
14358 one:
14359
14360 @example
14361 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
14362 @end example
14363
14364 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
14365 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
14366 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
14367 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
14368 taught about the new platform.
14369
14370 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
14371 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
14372 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
14373 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
14374 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
14375 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules do download it for
14376 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
14377 as well.
14378
14379 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
14380 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
14381 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
14382 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
14383 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
14384 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
14385 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
14386 reason.
14387
14388 @c *********************************************************************
14389 @include contributing.texi
14390
14391 @c *********************************************************************
14392 @node Acknowledgments
14393 @chapter Acknowledgments
14394
14395 Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
14396 which was designed and
14397 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
14398 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
14399 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
14400 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
14401 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
14402
14403 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
14404 an inspiration for Guix.
14405
14406 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
14407 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
14408 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
14409 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
14410 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
14411
14412
14413 @c *********************************************************************
14414 @node GNU Free Documentation License
14415 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
14416 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
14417 @include fdl-1.3.texi
14418
14419 @c *********************************************************************
14420 @node Concept Index
14421 @unnumbered Concept Index
14422 @printindex cp
14423
14424 @node Programming Index
14425 @unnumbered Programming Index
14426 @syncodeindex tp fn
14427 @syncodeindex vr fn
14428 @printindex fn
14429
14430 @bye
14431
14432 @c Local Variables:
14433 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
14434 @c End: